blob: 5c8dc852f75b7466bb2768746ad55c4ed66ebfc7 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
2 HAProxy
3 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau21475e32010-05-23 08:46:08 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau37242fa2010-08-28 19:21:00 +02007 2010/08/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
17 This document is formated with 80 columns per line, with even number of
18 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020050
514. Proxies
524.1. Proxy keywords matrix
534.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
54
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +0100555. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020056
576. HTTP header manipulation
58
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100597. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200607.1. Matching integers
617.2. Matching strings
627.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
637.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
647.5. Available matching criteria
657.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
667.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4
677.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
687.6. Pre-defined ACLs
697.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
Cyril Bonté7d38afb2010-02-03 20:41:26 +0100707.8. Pattern extraction
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020071
728. Logging
738.1. Log levels
748.2. Log formats
758.2.1. Default log format
768.2.2. TCP log format
778.2.3. HTTP log format
788.3. Advanced logging options
798.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
808.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
818.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
828.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
838.4. Timing events
848.5. Session state at disconnection
858.6. Non-printable characters
868.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
878.8. Capturing HTTP headers
888.9. Examples of logs
89
909. Statistics and monitoring
919.1. CSV format
929.2. Unix Socket commands
93
94
951. Quick reminder about HTTP
96----------------------------
97
98When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
99fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
100on almost anything found in the contents.
101
102However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
103formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
104correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
105
106
1071.1. The HTTP transaction model
108-------------------------------
109
110The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100111to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200112from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
113connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
114will involve a new connection :
115
116 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
117
118In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
119establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
120by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
121length.
122
123Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
124to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
125however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
126response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
127header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
128
129 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
130
131Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
132power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
133but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200134a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
136A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
137keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
138second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
139page :
140
141 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
142
143This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
144latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
145correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
146the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100147server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200149By default HAProxy operates in a tunnel-like mode with regards to persistent
150connections: for each connection it processes the first request and forwards
151everything else (including additional requests) to selected server. Once
152established, the connection is persisted both on the client and server
153sides. Use "option http-server-close" to preserve client persistent connections
154while handling every incoming request individually, dispatching them one after
155another to servers, in HTTP close mode. Use "option httpclose" to switch both
156sides to HTTP close mode. "option forceclose" and "option
157http-pretend-keepalive" help working around servers misbehaving in HTTP close
158mode.
159
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160
1611.2. HTTP request
162-----------------
163
164First, let's consider this HTTP request :
165
166 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100167 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200168 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
169 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
170 3 User-agent: my small browser
171 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
172 5 Accept: image/png
173
174
1751.2.1. The Request line
176-----------------------
177
178Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
179
180 - a METHOD : GET
181 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
182 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
183
184All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
185which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
186followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
187is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
188desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
189the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
190
191The URI itself can have several forms :
192
193 - A "relative URI" :
194
195 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
196
197 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
198 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
199
200 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
201
202 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
203
204 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
205 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
206 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
207 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
208 must accept this form too.
209
210 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
211 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
212 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
215 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
216 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
217 other protocols too.
218
219In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
220mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
221on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
222It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
223specific to the language, framework or application in use.
224
225
2261.2.2. The request headers
227--------------------------
228
229The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
230beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
231an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
232Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
233values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
234encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
235the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
236define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
237
238Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
239their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
240"Connection:" header).
241
242The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
243that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
244is one valid form of empty line.
245
246Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
247headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
248about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
249application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
250
251Important note:
252 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
253 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
254 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
255 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
256
257
2581.3. HTTP response
259------------------
260
261An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
262messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
263
264 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
267 2 Content-length: 350
268 3 Content-Type: text/html
269
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200270As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
271codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
272response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100273continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
274the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
275following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
276sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
277(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
278correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
279such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
280state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
281over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
282if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
283information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200284
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285
2861.3.1. The Response line
287------------------------
288
289Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
290
291 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
292 - a status code : 200
293 - a reason : OK
294
295The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
298 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
299 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
300 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
301
302Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100303"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
305messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
306or "Authentication Required".
307
308Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
309
310 Code When / reason
311 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
312 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
313 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
314 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
315 400 for an invalid or too large request
316 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
317 accessing the stats page)
318 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
319 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
320 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
321 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
322 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
323 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
324 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
325 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
326 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
327
328The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3294.2).
330
331
3321.3.2. The response headers
333---------------------------
334
335Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
336the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
337details.
338
339
3402. Configuring HAProxy
341----------------------
342
3432.1. Configuration file format
344------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200345
346HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
347
348 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
349 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
350 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
351 "frontend" and "backend".
352
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100353The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
354referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
355delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100356preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100357escaped by doubling them.
358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
3602.2. Time format
361----------------
362
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100363Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100364values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
365otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
366numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
367for every keyword. Supported units are :
368
369 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
370 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
371 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
372 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
373 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
374 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
375
376
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003772.3. Examples
378-------------
379
380 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
381 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
382 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
383 global
384 daemon
385 maxconn 256
386
387 defaults
388 mode http
389 timeout connect 5000ms
390 timeout client 50000ms
391 timeout server 50000ms
392
393 frontend http-in
394 bind *:80
395 default_backend servers
396
397 backend servers
398 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
399
400
401 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
402 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
403 global
404 daemon
405 maxconn 256
406
407 defaults
408 mode http
409 timeout connect 5000ms
410 timeout client 50000ms
411 timeout server 50000ms
412
413 listen http-in
414 bind *:80
415 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
416
417
418Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
419
420 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -d
421
422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004233. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200424--------------------
425
426Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
427are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
428of them have command-line equivalents.
429
430The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
431
432 * Process management and security
433 - chroot
434 - daemon
435 - gid
436 - group
437 - log
438 - nbproc
439 - pidfile
440 - uid
441 - ulimit-n
442 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200443 - stats
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200444 - node
445 - description
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100446
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200447 * Performance tuning
448 - maxconn
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100449 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - noepoll
451 - nokqueue
452 - nopoll
453 - nosepoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100454 - nosplice
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200455 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200456 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200457 - tune.chksize
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100458 - tune.maxaccept
459 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200460 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100461 - tune.rcvbuf.client
462 - tune.rcvbuf.server
463 - tune.sndbuf.client
464 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Debugging
467 - debug
468 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200469
470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004713.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200472------------------------------------
473
474chroot <jail dir>
475 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
476 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
477 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
478 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
479 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
480 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100481
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200482daemon
483 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
484 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
485 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
486
487gid <number>
488 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
489 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
490 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
491 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100492
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200493group <group name>
494 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
495 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100496
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200497log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200498 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
499 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100500 configured with "log global".
501
502 <address> can be one of:
503
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100504 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100505 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
506 port).
507
508 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
509 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
510 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
511 writeable).
512
513 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200514
515 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
516 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
517 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
518
519 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200520 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
521 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
522 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
523 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
524 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
525 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200526
527 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
528
529nbproc <number>
530 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
531 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
532 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
533 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
534 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
535
536pidfile <pidfile>
537 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
538 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
539 starting the process. See also "daemon".
540
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200541stats socket <path> [{uid | user} <uid>] [{gid | group} <gid>] [mode <mode>]
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200542 [level <level>]
543
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200544 Creates a UNIX socket in stream mode at location <path>. Any previously
545 existing socket will be backed up then replaced. Connections to this socket
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100546 will return various statistics outputs and even allow some commands to be
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200547 issued. Please consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
548
549 An optional "level" parameter can be specified to restrict the nature of
550 the commands that can be issued on the socket :
551 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
552 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
553 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
554
555 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
556 be read, and only non-sensible changes are permitted (eg: clear max
557 counters).
558
559 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
560 all counters).
Willy Tarreaua8efd362008-01-03 10:19:15 +0100561
562 On platforms which support it, it is possible to restrict access to this
563 socket by specifying numerical IDs after "uid" and "gid", or valid user and
564 group names after the "user" and "group" keywords. It is also possible to
565 restrict permissions on the socket by passing an octal value after the "mode"
566 keyword (same syntax as chmod). Depending on the platform, the permissions on
567 the socket will be inherited from the directory which hosts it, or from the
568 user the process is started with.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200569
570stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
571 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
572 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100573 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200574
575stats maxconn <connections>
576 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
577 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
578
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200579uid <number>
580 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
581 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
582 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
583 one. See also "gid" and "user".
584
585ulimit-n <number>
586 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
587 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
588 option.
589
590user <user name>
591 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
592 See also "uid" and "group".
593
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200594node <name>
595 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
596
597 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
598 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
599 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
600 traffic.
601
602description <text>
603 Add a text that describes the instance.
604
605 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
606 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
607 "<" and ">" characters.
608
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006103.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200611-----------------------
612
613maxconn <number>
614 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
615 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
616 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
617 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
618
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100619maxpipes <number>
620 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
621 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
622 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
623 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
624 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
625 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
626
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200627noepoll
628 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
629 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
630 used will generally be "poll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
631
632nokqueue
633 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
634 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
635 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
636
637nopoll
638 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
639 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100640 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200641 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll" and
642 "nokqueue".
643
644nosepoll
645 Disables the use of the "speculative epoll" event polling system on Linux. It
646 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-ds". The next polling system
647 used will generally be "epoll". See also "nosepoll", and "nopoll".
648
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100649nosplice
650 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
651 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
652 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100653 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100654 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
655 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
656 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
657 "option splice-response".
658
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200659spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
660 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending health checks to servers at exact
661 intervals, for instance when many logical servers are located on the same
662 physical server. With the help of this parameter, it becomes possible to add
663 some randomness in the check interval between 0 and +/- 50%. A value between
664 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The default value remains at 0.
665
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200666tune.bufsize <number>
667 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
668 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
669 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
670 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
671 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
672 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
673 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
674 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
675
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200676tune.chksize <number>
677 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
678 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
679 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
680 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
681 checks whenever possible.
682
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100683tune.maxaccept <number>
684 Sets the maximum number of consecutive accepts that a process may perform on
685 a single wake up. High values give higher priority to high connection rates,
686 while lower values give higher priority to already established connections.
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100687 This value is limited to 100 by default in single process mode. However, in
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100688 multi-process mode (nbproc > 1), it defaults to 8 so that when one process
689 wakes up, it does not take all incoming connections for itself and leaves a
Willy Tarreauf49d1df2009-03-01 08:35:41 +0100690 part of them to other processes. Setting this value to -1 completely disables
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100691 the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
692
693tune.maxpollevents <number>
694 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
695 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
696 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
697 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
698 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
699
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200700tune.maxrewrite <number>
701 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
702 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
703 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
704 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
705 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
706 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
707 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
708 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
709 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
710 bufsize.
711
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100712tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
713tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
714 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
715 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
716 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
717 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
718 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
719 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
720 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
721
722tune.sndbuf.client <number>
723tune.sndbuf.server <number>
724 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
725 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
726 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
727 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
728 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
729 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
730 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
731 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
732 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
733 notifying haproxy again.
734
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007363.3. Debugging
737--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200738
739debug
740 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
741 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
742 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
743 system startup.
744
745quiet
746 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
747 line argument "-q".
748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007493.4. Userlists
750--------------
751It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
752http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
753it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
754
755userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100756 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100757 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
758
759group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100760 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100761 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
762 proceeded by "users" keyword.
763
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100764user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
765 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100766 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
767 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100768 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
769 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100770 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
771 DES-based method of crypting passwords.
772
773
774 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100775 userlist L1
776 group G1 users tiger,scott
777 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100778
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100779 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
780 user scott insecure-password elgato
781 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100782
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100783 userlist L2
784 group G1
785 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100786
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +0100787 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
788 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
789 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100790
791 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007934. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200794----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100795
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200796Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
797 - defaults <name>
798 - frontend <name>
799 - backend <name>
800 - listen <name>
801
802A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
803its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
804section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100805section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200806
807A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
808connections.
809
810A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
811to forward incoming connections.
812
813A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
814parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
815
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100816All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
817'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
818case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
819
820Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
821logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
822proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
823However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
824name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
825
826Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
827and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100828bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100829protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
830modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
831arbitrary criteria.
832
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008344.1. Proxy keywords matrix
835--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100836
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200837The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
838limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
839they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
840limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100841marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200842option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +0200843and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
844with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
845specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100846
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200847
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100848 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
849------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
850acl - X X X
851appsession - - X X
852backlog X X X -
853balance X - X X
854bind - X X -
855bind-process X X X X
856block - X X X
857capture cookie - X X -
858capture request header - X X -
859capture response header - X X -
860clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
861contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
862cookie X - X X
863default-server X - X X
864default_backend X X X -
865description - X X X
866disabled X X X X
867dispatch - - X X
868enabled X X X X
869errorfile X X X X
870errorloc X X X X
871errorloc302 X X X X
872-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
873errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200874force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100875fullconn X - X X
876grace X X X X
877hash-type X - X X
878http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +0100879http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +0200880http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100881http-request - X X X
882id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +0200883ignore-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100884log X X X X
885maxconn X X X -
886mode X X X X
887monitor fail - X X -
888monitor-net X X X -
889monitor-uri X X X -
890option abortonclose (*) X - X X
891option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
892option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
893option allbackups (*) X - X X
894option checkcache (*) X - X X
895option clitcpka (*) X X X -
896option contstats (*) X X X -
897option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
898option dontlognull (*) X X X -
899option forceclose (*) X X X X
900-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
901option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +0200902option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100903option http-server-close (*) X X X X
904option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
905option httpchk X - X X
906option httpclose (*) X X X X
907option httplog X X X X
908option http_proxy (*) X X X X
909option independant-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +0200910option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100911option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
912option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
913option logasap (*) X X X -
914option mysql-check X - X X
915option nolinger (*) X X X X
916option originalto X X X X
917option persist (*) X - X X
918option redispatch (*) X - X X
919option smtpchk X - X X
920option socket-stats (*) X X X -
921option splice-auto (*) X X X X
922option splice-request (*) X X X X
923option splice-response (*) X X X X
924option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
925option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
926-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
927option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
928option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
929option tcpka X X X X
930option tcplog X X X X
931option transparent (*) X - X X
932persist rdp-cookie X - X X
933rate-limit sessions X X X -
934redirect - X X X
935redisp (deprecated) X - X X
936redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
937reqadd - X X X
938reqallow - X X X
939reqdel - X X X
940reqdeny - X X X
941reqiallow - X X X
942reqidel - X X X
943reqideny - X X X
944reqipass - X X X
945reqirep - X X X
946reqisetbe - X X X
947reqitarpit - X X X
948reqpass - X X X
949reqrep - X X X
950-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
951reqsetbe - X X X
952reqtarpit - X X X
953retries X - X X
954rspadd - X X X
955rspdel - X X X
956rspdeny - X X X
957rspidel - X X X
958rspideny - X X X
959rspirep - X X X
960rsprep - X X X
961server - - X X
962source X - X X
963srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
964stats auth X - X X
965stats enable X - X X
966stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +0200967stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100968stats realm X - X X
969stats refresh X - X X
970stats scope X - X X
971stats show-desc X - X X
972stats show-legends X - X X
973stats show-node X - X X
974stats uri X - X X
975-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
976stick match - - X X
977stick on - - X X
978stick store-request - - X X
979stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +0200980tcp-request connection - X X -
981tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +0200982tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +0100983timeout check X - X X
984timeout client X X X -
985timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
986timeout connect X - X X
987timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
988timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
989timeout http-request X X X X
990timeout queue X - X X
991timeout server X - X X
992timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
993timeout tarpit X X X X
994transparent (deprecated) X - X X
995use_backend - X X -
996------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
997 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100999
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010004.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1001---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001002
1003This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1004
1005
1006acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1007 Declare or complete an access list.
1008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1009 no | yes | yes | yes
1010 Example:
1011 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1012 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1013 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001015 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001016
1017
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001018appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1019 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001020 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1022 no | no | yes | yes
1023 Arguments :
1024 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1025 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1026
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001027 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001028 checked in each cookie value.
1029
1030 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1031 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1032 milliseconds.
1033
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001034 request-learn
1035 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1036 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1037 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1038 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1039 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1040 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1041
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001042 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1043 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1044 data following this prefix.
1045
1046 Example :
1047 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1048
1049 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1050 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1051
1052 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1053 2 modes are currently supported :
1054 - path-parameters :
1055 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1056 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1057 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1058 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1059 - query-string :
1060 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1061 query string.
1062
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001063 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1064 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1065 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1066 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001067 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1068 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1069 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001070 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1071 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1072
1073 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1074
1075 Example :
1076 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1077
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001078 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001079 and "ignore-persist"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001080
1081
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001082backlog <conns>
1083 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1085 yes | yes | yes | no
1086 Arguments :
1087 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1088 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
1089 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
1090
1091 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1092 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1093 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1094 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1095 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1096 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1097 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1098 backlog parameter.
1099
1100 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1101 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1102 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1103
1104 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1105
1106
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001107balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001108balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001109 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1110 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1111 yes | no | yes | yes
1112 Arguments :
1113 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1114 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1115 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1116 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1117
1118 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1119 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1120 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1121 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001122 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
1123 design to 4128 active servers per backend. Note that in some
1124 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1125 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1126 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1127 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1128 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1129 it, so that you don't worry.
1130
1131 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1132 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1133 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1134 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1135 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1136 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1137 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1138 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001139
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001140 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1141 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1142 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1143 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1144 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1145 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1146 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1147 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1148
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001149 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1150 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1151 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1152 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1153 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1154 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1155 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1156 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001157 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001158 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001159 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1160 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1161 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001162
1163 uri The left part of the URI (before the question mark) is hashed
1164 and divided by the total weight of the running servers. The
1165 result designates which server will receive the request. This
1166 ensures that a same URI will always be directed to the same
1167 server as long as no server goes up or down. This is used
1168 with proxy caches and anti-virus proxies in order to maximize
1169 the cache hit rate. Note that this algorithm may only be used
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001170 in an HTTP backend. This algorithm is static by default,
1171 which means that changing a server's weight on the fly will
1172 have no effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001173
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001174 This algorithm support two optional parameters "len" and
1175 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1176 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1177 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1178 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1179 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1180 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1181 URIs start with a leading "/".
1182
1183 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1184 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1185 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1186 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1187
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001188 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001189 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1190
1191 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
1192 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1193 when the question mark indicating a query string ('?') is not
1194 present in the URL. Optionally, specify a number of octets to
1195 wait for before attempting to search the message body. If the
1196 entity can not be searched, then round robin is used for each
1197 request. For instance, if your clients always send the LB
1198 parameter in the first 128 bytes, then specify that. The
1199 default is 48. The entity data will not be scanned until the
1200 required number of octets have arrived at the gateway, this
1201 is the minimum of: (default/max_wait, Content-Length or first
1202 chunk length). If Content-Length is missing or zero, it does
1203 not need to wait for more data than the client promised to
1204 send. When Content-Length is present and larger than
1205 <max_wait>, then waiting is limited to <max_wait> and it is
1206 assumed that this will be enough data to search for the
1207 presence of the parameter. In the unlikely event that
1208 Transfer-Encoding: chunked is used, only the first chunk is
1209 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
1210 be randomly balanced if at all.
1211
1212 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1213 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1214 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1215 server will receive the request.
1216
1217 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1218 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1219 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1220 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1221 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001222 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1223 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1224 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001225
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001226 hdr(name) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP request.
1227 Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function, the header
1228 name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the header is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001229 absent or if it does not contain any value, the roundrobin
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001230 algorithm is applied instead.
1231
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001232 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001233 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1234 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1235 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1236
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001237 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1238 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1239 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1240
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001241 rdp-cookie
1242 rdp-cookie(name)
1243 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1244 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1245 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1246 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1247 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1248 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001249 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001250 used instead.
1251
1252 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1253 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1254 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1255 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1256
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001257 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1258 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1259 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1260
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001261 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001262 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1263 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001264
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001265 balance uri [len <len>] [depth <depth>]
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001266 balance url_param <param> [check_post [<max_wait>]]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001267
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001268 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1269 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1270 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001271
1272 Examples :
1273 balance roundrobin
1274 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001275 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001276 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1277 balance hdr(host)
1278 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001279
1280 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1281 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001283 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001284 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1285 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1286 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1287 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1288
1289 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1290 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1291 defaults to 16 kB.
1292
1293 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1294 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1295
1296 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1297 Round Robin.
1298
1299 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1300 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1301 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1302 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1303
1304 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1305
1306 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001307 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001308 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1309 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1310 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001311
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001312 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1313 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001314
1315
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001316bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...]
1317bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] interface <interface>
1318bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] mss <maxseg>
1319bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] transparent
1320bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] id <id>
1321bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] name <name>
1322bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] defer-accept
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001323 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1325 no | yes | yes | no
1326 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001327 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1328 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1329 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1330 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
1331 special address "0.0.0.0".
1332
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001333 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1334 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
1335 above. The port is mandatory. Note that in the case of an
1336 IPv6 address, the port is always the number after the last
1337 colon (':'). A range can either be :
1338 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1339 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1340 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1341 the range.
1342
1343 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1344 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1345 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1346 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1347 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1348 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1349 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
1350 privileges to start the program, which are independant of
1351 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001352
Willy Tarreau5e6e2042009-02-04 17:19:29 +01001353 <interface> is an optional physical interface name. This is currently
1354 only supported on Linux. The interface must be a physical
1355 interface, not an aliased interface. When specified, all
1356 addresses on the same line will only be accepted if the
1357 incoming packet physically come through the designated
1358 interface. It is also possible to bind multiple frontends to
1359 the same address if they are bound to different interfaces.
1360 Note that binding to a physical interface requires root
1361 privileges.
1362
Willy Tarreaube1b9182009-06-14 18:48:19 +02001363 <maxseg> is an optional TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be
1364 advertised on incoming connections. This can be used to force
1365 a lower MSS for certain specific ports, for instance for
1366 connections passing through a VPN. Note that this relies on a
1367 kernel feature which is theorically supported under Linux but
1368 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not
1369 work on other operating systems. The commonly advertised
1370 value on Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP).
1371
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02001372 <id> is a persistent value for socket ID. Must be positive and
1373 unique in the proxy. An unused value will automatically be
1374 assigned if unset. Can only be used when defining only a
1375 single socket.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02001376
1377 <name> is an optional name provided for stats
1378
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001379 transparent is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
1380 Linux kernels. It indicates that the addresses will be bound
1381 even if they do not belong to the local machine. Any packet
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001382 targeting any of these addresses will be caught just as if
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001383 the address was locally configured. This normally requires
1384 that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with
1385 the default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for
1386 the specified port. This keyword is available only when
1387 HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001388
Willy Tarreau59f89202010-10-02 11:54:00 +02001389 defer-accept is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain
Willy Tarreaucb6cd432009-10-13 07:34:14 +02001390 Linux kernels. It states that a connection will only be
1391 accepted once some data arrive on it, or at worst after the
1392 first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols for
1393 which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly
1394 improve performance by ensuring that most of the request is
1395 already available when the connection is accepted. On the
1396 other hand, it will not be able to detect connections which
1397 don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
1398 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is
1399 never accepted until the client talks. This can cause issues
1400 with front firewalls which would see an established
1401 connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV.
1402
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001403 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1404 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1405 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1406 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1407 in a frontend.
1408
1409 Example :
1410 listen http_proxy
1411 bind :80,:443
1412 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
1413
1414 See also : "source".
1415
1416
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001417bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-32> ] ...
1418 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1420 yes | yes | yes | yes
1421 Arguments :
1422 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1423 may be used to override a default value.
1424
1425 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...31. This
1426 option may be combined with other numbers.
1427
1428 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...32. This
1429 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1430 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1431 missing from all processes.
1432
1433 number The instance will be enabled on this process number, between
1434 1 and 32. You must be careful not to reference a process
1435 number greater than the configured global.nbproc, otherwise
1436 some instances might be missing from all processes.
1437
1438 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1439 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1440 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1441 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1442 and 'even' instances.
1443
1444 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 processes using
1445 this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups. Please
1446 note that 'all' really means all processes and is not limited to the first
1447 32.
1448
1449 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1450 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1451
1452 Example :
1453 listen app_ip1
1454 bind 10.0.0.1:80
1455 bind_process odd
1456
1457 listen app_ip2
1458 bind 10.0.0.2:80
1459 bind_process even
1460
1461 listen management
1462 bind 10.0.0.3:80
1463 bind_process 1 2 3 4
1464
1465 See also : "nbproc" in global section.
1466
1467
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001468block { if | unless } <condition>
1469 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1471 no | yes | yes | yes
1472
1473 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1474 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001475 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001476 typically used to deny access to certain sensible resources if some
1477 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1478 "block" statements per instance.
1479
1480 Example:
1481 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1482 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1483 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1484 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1485
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001486 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001487
1488
1489capture cookie <name> len <length>
1490 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1492 no | yes | yes | no
1493 Arguments :
1494 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1495 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1496 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1497 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1498 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1499
1500 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1501 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1502 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1503 right if it exceeds <length>.
1504
1505 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1506 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1507 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1508 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1509
1510 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1511 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1512 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1513
1514 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1515 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1516 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
1517 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001518 configured in the sources by default to 64 characters. It is not possible to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001519 specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1520
1521 Example:
1522 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1523
1524 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001525 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001526
1527
1528capture request header <name> len <length>
1529 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified request header.
1530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1531 no | yes | yes | no
1532 Arguments :
1533 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001534 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001535 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1536 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1537 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1538
1539 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1540 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1541 it exceeds <length>.
1542
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001543 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001544 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1545 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001546 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1547 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1548 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1549 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001550 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001551 environments to find where the request came from.
1552
1553 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1554 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1555 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1556 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001557
1558 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers, but each capture
1559 is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent for a
1560 same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It is not
1561 possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1562
1563 Example:
1564 capture request header Host len 15
1565 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1566 capture request header Referrer len 15
1567
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001568 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001569 about logging.
1570
1571
1572capture response header <name> len <length>
1573 Capture and log the first occurrence of the specified response header.
1574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1575 no | yes | yes | no
1576 Arguments :
1577 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001578 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001579 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
1580 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1581 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1582
1583 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1584 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1585 it exceeds <length>.
1586
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001587 Only the first value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001588 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
1589 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
1590 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001591 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
1592 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
1593 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
1594 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001595
1596 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers, but each
1597 capture is limited to 64 characters. In order to keep log format consistent
1598 for a same frontend, header captures can only be declared in a frontend. It
1599 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
1600
1601 Example:
1602 capture response header Content-length len 9
1603 capture response header Location len 15
1604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001605 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001606 about logging.
1607
1608
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001609clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001610 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
1611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1612 yes | yes | yes | no
1613 Arguments :
1614 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1615 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1616 as explained at the top of this document.
1617
1618 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
1619 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
1620 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
1621 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
1622 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
1623 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
1624 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
1625 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001626 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001627 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
1628 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
1629
1630 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
1631 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1632 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1633 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1634 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
1635 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1636
1637 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
1638 Please use "timeout client" instead.
1639
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01001640 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
1641 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001642
1643
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001644contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001645 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
1646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1647 yes | no | yes | yes
1648 Arguments :
1649 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
1650 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1651 as explained at the top of this document.
1652
1653 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001654 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001655 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001656 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
1657 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
1658 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
1659 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
1660
1661 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
1662 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
1663 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
1664 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
1665 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
1666 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
1667
1668 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
1669 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
1670 instead.
1671
1672 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
1673 "timeout server", "contimeout".
1674
1675
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02001676cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001677 [ postonly ] [ domain <domain> ]*
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001678 [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001679 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
1680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1681 yes | no | yes | yes
1682 Arguments :
1683 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
1684 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
1685 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
1686 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
1687 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
1688 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
1689 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
1690 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
1691 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
1692
1693 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
1694 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
1695 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
1696 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
1697 headers is left to the application. The application can then
1698 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
1699 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
1700 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
1701 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
1702 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
1703 "insert" and "prefix".
1704
1705 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001706 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
1707 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
1708 server. If the server emits a cookie with the same name, it will
1709 be remove before processing. For this reason, this mode can be
1710 used to upgrade existing configurations running in the "rewrite"
1711 mode. The cookie will only be a session cookie and will not be
1712 stored on the client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect"
1713 option is added, the server will see the cookies emitted by the
1714 client. Due to caching effects, it is generally wise to add the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001715 "nocache" or "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert"
1716 keyword is not compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
1717
1718 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
1719 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
1720 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
1721 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
1722 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
1723 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
1724 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
1725 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
1726 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
1727 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
1728 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert".
1729
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02001730 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
1731 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
1732 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
1733 it will be removed. In "insert" mode, this will additionally
1734 remove cookies from requests transmitted to the server, making
1735 the persistence mechanism totally transparent from an application
1736 point of view.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001737
1738 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
1739 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
1740 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
1741 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
1742 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
1743 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
1744 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
1745 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
1746 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
1747
1748 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
1749 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
1750 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
1751 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
1752 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
1753 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
1754 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
1755 persistence cookie in the cache.
1756 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
1757
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001758 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001759 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01001760 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
1761 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
1762 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
1763 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
1764 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
1765 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02001766
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001767 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
1768 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
1769 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
1770 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
1771 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
1772 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
1773 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
1774 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1775 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
1776 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
1777 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
1778 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
1779 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
1780 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
1781 the site.
1782
1783 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
1784 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
1785 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
1786 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
1787 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
1788 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
1789 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
1790 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
1791 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
1792 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
1793 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
1794 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
1795 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
1796 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
1797 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
1798 redispatch after some absolute delay.
1799
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001800 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
1801 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
1802 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
1803 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001804
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001805 Examples :
1806 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
1807 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
1808 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02001809 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001810
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02001811 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001812 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001813
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001814
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001815default-server [param*]
1816 Change default options for a server in a backend
1817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1818 yes | no | yes | yes
1819 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001820 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1821 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1822 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1823 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001824
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001825 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01001826 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
1827
1828 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001829
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01001830
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001831default_backend <backend>
1832 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
1833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1834 yes | yes | yes | no
1835 Arguments :
1836 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
1837
1838 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
1839 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
1840 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
1841 will catch all undetermined requests.
1842
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001843 Example :
1844
1845 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
1846 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
1847 default_backend dynamic
1848
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001849 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
1850
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001851
1852disabled
1853 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
1854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1855 yes | yes | yes | yes
1856 Arguments : none
1857
1858 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
1859 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
1860 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
1861 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
1862 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
1863 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
1864 keyword in a "defaults" section.
1865
1866 See also : "enabled"
1867
1868
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02001869dispatch <address>:<port>
1870 Set a default server address
1871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1872 no | no | yes | yes
1873 Arguments : none
1874
1875 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
1876 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
1877 during start-up.
1878
1879 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
1880 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
1881 possible with normal servers.
1882
1883 The "disabled" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
1884 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
1885 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
1886 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
1887 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
1888
1889 See also : "server"
1890
1891
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001892enabled
1893 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
1894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1895 yes | yes | yes | yes
1896 Arguments : none
1897
1898 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
1899 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
1900
1901 See also : "disabled"
1902
1903
1904errorfile <code> <file>
1905 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
1906 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1907 yes | yes | yes | yes
1908 Arguments :
1909 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
1910 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
1911
1912 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001913 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001914 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01001915 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
1916 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001917
1918 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
1919 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
1920 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
1921
1922 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
1923 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
1924 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
1925 files returning the same contents as default errors.
1926
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01001927 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
1928 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
1929 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
1930 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
1931 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
1932 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
1933
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001934 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
1935 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
1936 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01001937 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001938 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
1939
1940 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
1941
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01001942 Example :
1943 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
1944 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
1945 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
1946
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001947
1948errorloc <code> <url>
1949errorloc302 <code> <url>
1950 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
1951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1952 yes | yes | yes | yes
1953 Arguments :
1954 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
1955 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
1956
1957 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
1958 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
1959 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
1960 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
1961 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
1962
1963 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
1964 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
1965 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
1966
1967 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
1968 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
1969 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
1970 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
1971 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
1972 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
1973 request.
1974
1975 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
1976
1977
1978errorloc303 <code> <url>
1979 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
1980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1981 yes | yes | yes | yes
1982 Arguments :
1983 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
1984 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
1985
1986 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
1987 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
1988 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
1989 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
1990 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
1991
1992 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
1993 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
1994 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
1995
1996 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
1997 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
1998 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
1999 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002000 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002001
2002 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2003
2004
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002005force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2006 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2007 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2008 no | yes | yes | yes
2009
2010 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2011 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2012 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2013 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2014 marked down for maintenance operations.
2015
2016 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2017 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2018 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2019 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2020 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2021 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2022 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2023 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2024 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2025
2026 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2027 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2028 is used.
2029
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002030 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002031 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002032
2033
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002034fullconn <conns>
2035 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2037 yes | no | yes | yes
2038 Arguments :
2039 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2040 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2041
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002042 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002043 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002044 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002045 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2046 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2047 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2048 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2049 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002050 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002051
2052 Example :
2053 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2054 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2055 # connections.
2056 backend dynamic
2057 fullconn 10000
2058 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2059 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2060
2061 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2062
2063
2064grace <time>
2065 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2066 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002067 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002068 Arguments :
2069 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2070 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2071 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2072
2073 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2074 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002075 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002076 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2077
2078 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2079 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2080 simplify it.
2081
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002082
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002083hash-type <method>
2084 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2086 yes | no | yes | yes
2087 Arguments :
2088 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2089 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but will
2090 be static in that weight changes while a server is up will be
2091 ignored. This means that there will be no slow start. Also,
2092 since a server is selected by its position in the array, most
2093 mappings are changed when the server count changes. This means
2094 that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is added
2095 to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to different
2096 servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for instance.
2097
2098 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2099 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2100 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2101 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2102 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2103 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a server
2104 is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings are
2105 redistributed, making it an ideal algorithm for caches.
2106 However, due to its principle, the algorithm will never be very
2107 smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a server's
2108 weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution. In order
2109 to get the same distribution on multiple load balancers, it is
2110 important that all servers have the same IDs.
2111
2112 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages.
2113
2114 See also : "balance", "server"
2115
2116
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002117http-check disable-on-404
2118 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002120 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002121 Arguments : none
2122
2123 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2124 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2125 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2126 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2127 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2128 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2129 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2130 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002131 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2132 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2133 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2134
2135 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2136
2137
2138http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
2139 Make HTTP health checks consider reponse contents or specific status codes
2140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2141 no | no | yes | yes
2142 Arguments :
2143 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2144 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
2145 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceeded by an
2146 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2147 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2148 details on the supported keywords.
2149
2150 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2151 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2152 with the usual backslash ('\').
2153
2154 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2155 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2156 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2157 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2158 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2159
2160 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
2161 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2162 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2163 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2164 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2165
2166 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
2167 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2168 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2169 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2170 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2171 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2172
2173 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
2174 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2175 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2176 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2177 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2178 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2179 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2180 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2181 trace).
2182
2183 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
2184 A health check respose will be considered valid if the
2185 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2186 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2187 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2188 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2189 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2190 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2191
2192 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2193 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2194 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2195 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2196 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2197 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2198 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2199 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2200
2201 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2202 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2203
2204 Examples :
2205 # only accept status 200 as valid
2206 http-request expect status 200
2207
2208 # consider SQL errors as errors
2209 http-request expect ! string SQL\ Error
2210
2211 # consider status 5xx only as errors
2212 http-request expect ! rstatus ^5
2213
2214 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
2215 http-request expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002216
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002217 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002218
2219
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002220http-check send-state
2221 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2223 yes | no | yes | yes
2224 Arguments : none
2225
2226 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2227 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2228 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2229 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2230 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2231
2232 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2233 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2234 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2235 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2236 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2237 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2238 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2239 checked in multiple backends.
2240
2241 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2242 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2243
2244 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2245 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2246 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2247 one fails.
2248
2249 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2250 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2251 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2252
2253 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2254 server's queue.
2255
2256 Example of a header received by the application server :
2257 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2258 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2259
2260 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2261
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002262http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002263 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002264 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2265
2266 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2267 no | yes | yes | yes
2268
2269 These set of options allow to fine control access to a
2270 frontend/listen/backend. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
2271 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002272 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
2273 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002274 should be asked to enter a username and password.
2275
2276 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
2277 instance.
2278
2279 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002280 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
2281 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
2282 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002283
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002284 http-request allow if nagios
2285 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
2286 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
2287 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002288
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002289 Example:
2290 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002291
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002292 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002293
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02002294 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
2295 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002296
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002297id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02002298 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
2299 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2300 no | yes | yes | yes
2301 Arguments : none
2302
2303 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
2304 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
2305 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01002306
2307
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002308ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2309 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
2310 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2311 no | yes | yes | yes
2312
2313 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
2314 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
2315 and running).
2316
2317 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2318 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
2319 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
2320 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
2321 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
2322
2323 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
2324 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
2325
2326 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2327 "unless" condition is met.
2328
2329 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
2330
2331
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002332log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002333log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002334 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
2335 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2336 yes | yes | yes | yes
2337 Arguments :
2338 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
2339 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
2340 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
2341 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
2342 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
2343 parameter.
2344
2345 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
2346 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
2347
2348 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
2349 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
2350 standard syslog port).
2351
2352 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
2353 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
2354 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
2355 appropriately writeable).
2356
2357 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
2358
2359 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
2360 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
2361 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
2362
2363 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
2364 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
2365 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002366 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
2367 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
2368 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
2369 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
2370 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002371
2372 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
2373
2374 Note that up to two "log" entries may be specified per instance. However, if
2375 "log global" is used and if the "global" section already contains 2 log
2376 entries, then additional log entries will be ignored.
2377
2378 Also, it is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002379 what to log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log
2380 entries from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level
2381 "info".
2382
2383 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
2384 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
2385 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
2386 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
2387
2388 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
2389 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002390
2391 Example :
2392 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02002393 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
2394 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002395
2396
2397maxconn <conns>
2398 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
2399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2400 yes | yes | yes | no
2401 Arguments :
2402 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
2403 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
2404 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
2405 closes.
2406
2407 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
2408 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
2409 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
2410 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
2411 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
2412 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
2413 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
2414 properly tuned.
2415
2416 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
2417 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
2418 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
2419
2420 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
2421
2422
2423mode { tcp|http|health }
2424 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
2425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2426 yes | yes | yes | yes
2427 Arguments :
2428 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
2429 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
2430 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
2431 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
2432
2433 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
2434 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
2435 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
2436 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
2437 brings HAProxy most of its value.
2438
2439 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
2440 to incoming connections and close the connection. Nothing will be
2441 logged. This mode is used to reply to external components health
2442 checks. This mode is deprecated and should not be used anymore as
2443 it is possible to do the same and even better by combining TCP or
2444 HTTP modes with the "monitor" keyword.
2445
2446 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
2447 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
2448 will be refused.
2449
2450 Example :
2451 defaults http_instances
2452 mode http
2453
2454 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
2455
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002456
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002457monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002458 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2460 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461 Arguments :
2462 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
2463 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002464 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002465 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
2466 backend and its backup.
2467
2468 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
2469 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
2470 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
2471 servers in a list of backends.
2472
2473 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
2474 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
2475 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
2476 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
2477 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
2478 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
2479 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002480 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002481
2482 Example:
2483 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002484 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002485 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
2486 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
2487 monitor-uri /site_alive
2488 monitor fail if site_dead
2489
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002490 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri"
2491
2492
2493monitor-net <source>
2494 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
2495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2496 yes | yes | yes | no
2497 Arguments :
2498 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
2499 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
2500 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
2501 followed by a mask.
2502
2503 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
2504 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002505 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002506 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
2507
2508 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
2509 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
2510 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
2511 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
2512 running without forwarding the request to a backend server.
2513
2514 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2515 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2516 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2517 nothing more. Right now, it is not possible to set failure conditions on
2518 requests caught by "monitor-net".
2519
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01002520 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
2521 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
2522
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002523 Example :
2524 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
2525 frontend www
2526 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
2527
2528 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
2529
2530
2531monitor-uri <uri>
2532 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
2533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2534 yes | yes | yes | no
2535 Arguments :
2536 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
2537 health status instead of forwarding the request.
2538
2539 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
2540 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
2541 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
2542 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
2543 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
2544 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
2545 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
2546 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
2547
2548 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
2549 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
2550 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
2551 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
2552 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
2553 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
2554
2555 Example :
2556 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
2557 frontend www
2558 mode http
2559 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
2560
2561 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
2562
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002563
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002564option abortonclose
2565no option abortonclose
2566 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
2567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2568 yes | no | yes | yes
2569 Arguments : none
2570
2571 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
2572 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
2573 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
2574 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002575 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002576 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
2577 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
2578 encountered while delivering the response.
2579
2580 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
2581 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
2582 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
2583 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
2584 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
2585 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002586 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002587 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002588 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002589 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
2590 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
2591 still not served and not pollute the servers.
2592
2593 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
2594 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
2595 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
2596 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
2597 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
2598 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
2599 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
2600 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002601 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002602
2603 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2604 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2605
2606 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
2607
2608
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02002609option accept-invalid-http-request
2610no option accept-invalid-http-request
2611 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
2612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2613 yes | yes | yes | no
2614 Arguments : none
2615
2616 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2617 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2618 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2619 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2620 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2621 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2622 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2623 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2624 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2625
2626 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2627 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2628 been confirmed.
2629
2630 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2631 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
2632 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Doing this
2633 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2634
2635 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2636 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2637
2638 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
2639 stats socket.
2640
2641
2642option accept-invalid-http-response
2643no option accept-invalid-http-response
2644 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
2645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2646 yes | no | yes | yes
2647 Arguments : none
2648
2649 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
2650 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
2651 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
2652 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
2653 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
2654 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
2655 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
2656 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
2657 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
2658
2659 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
2660 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
2661 been confirmed.
2662
2663 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
2664 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
2665 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
2666 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
2667
2668 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2669 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2670
2671 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
2672 stats socket.
2673
2674
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002675option allbackups
2676no option allbackups
2677 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
2678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2679 yes | no | yes | yes
2680 Arguments : none
2681
2682 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
2683 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
2684 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
2685 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
2686 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
2687 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
2688 order between the backup servers anymore.
2689
2690 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
2691 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
2692
2693 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2694 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2695
2696
2697option checkcache
2698no option checkcache
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002699 Analyze all server responses and block requests with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2701 yes | no | yes | yes
2702 Arguments : none
2703
2704 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
2705 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002706 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002707 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
2708 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
2709 some sensible session information go in the wild.
2710
2711 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002712 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002713 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002714 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
2715 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002716 to the client are :
2717 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002718 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002719 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002720 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
2721 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
2722 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
2723 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
2724 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
2725 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
2726 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
2727 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
2728 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
2729 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
2730 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
2731
2732 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002733 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002734 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002735 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002736 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
2737
2738 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
2739 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002740 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002741 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
2742
2743 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2744 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2745
2746
2747option clitcpka
2748no option clitcpka
2749 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
2750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2751 yes | yes | yes | no
2752 Arguments : none
2753
2754 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
2755 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
2756 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
2757 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
2758
2759 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
2760 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
2761 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
2762 operating system and its tuning parameters.
2763
2764 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
2765 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
2766 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
2767 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
2768 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
2769
2770 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
2771
2772 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
2773 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
2774 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
2775
2776 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2777 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2778
2779 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
2780
2781
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002782option contstats
2783 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
2784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2785 yes | yes | yes | no
2786 Arguments : none
2787
2788 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
2789 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
2790 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
2791 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
2792 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
2793 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
2794 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
2795
2796
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002797option dontlog-normal
2798no option dontlog-normal
2799 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
2800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2801 yes | yes | yes | no
2802 Arguments : none
2803
2804 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
2805 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
2806 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
2807 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
2808 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
2809 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
2810 logged.
2811
2812 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
2813 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
2814 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
2815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002816 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02002817 logging.
2818
2819
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002820option dontlognull
2821no option dontlognull
2822 Enable or disable logging of null connections
2823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2824 yes | yes | yes | no
2825 Arguments : none
2826
2827 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
2828 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
2829 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
2830 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
2831 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
2832 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
2833 which typically corresponds to those probes.
2834
2835 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
2836 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
2837 would not be logged.
2838
2839 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2840 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002842 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002843
2844
2845option forceclose
2846no option forceclose
2847 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
2848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01002849 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002850 Arguments : none
2851
2852 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
2853 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
2854 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
2855 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
2856 global session times in the logs.
2857
2858 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01002859 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01002860 to respond. This option implicitly enables the "httpclose" option. Note that
2861 this option also enables the parsing of the full request and response, which
2862 means we can close the connection to the server very quickly, releasing some
2863 resources earlier than with httpclose.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002864
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002865 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
2866 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
2867 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
2868
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002869 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2870 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2871
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002872 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01002873
2874
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002875option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002876 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
2877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2878 yes | yes | yes | yes
2879 Arguments :
2880 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
2881 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002882 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002883 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002884
2885 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
2886 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
2887 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
2888 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
2889 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
2890 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
2891 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002892 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
2893 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
2894 possible that the client has already brought one.
2895
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002896 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002897 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002898 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
2899 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002900 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
2901 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002902
2903 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
2904 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
2905 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
2906 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
2907 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
2908 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
2909 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
2910
2911 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002912 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
2913 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
2914 both are defined.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002915
2916 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
2917 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
2918 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
2919 when using this option.
2920
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002921 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002922 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
2923 frontend www
2924 mode http
2925 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
2926
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02002927 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
2928 backend www
2929 mode http
2930 option forwardfor header X-Client
2931
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002932 See also : "option httpclose"
2933
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002934
2935option http-pretend-keepalive
2936no option http-pretend-keepalive
2937 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
2938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2939 yes | yes | yes | yes
2940 Arguments : none
2941
2942 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
2943 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
2944 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
2945 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
2946 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
2947 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
2948 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
2949 consider the response complete.
2950
2951 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
2952 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
2953 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
2954 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
2955 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
2956 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
2957
2958 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
2959 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
2960 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
2961 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
2962 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
2963 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
2964 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
2965
2966 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
2967 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02002968 This option may be compbined with "option httpclose", which will cause
2969 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
2970 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02002971
2972 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
2973 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
2974
2975 See also : "option forceclose" and "option http-server-close"
2976
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002977
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01002978option http-server-close
2979no option http-server-close
2980 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
2981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2982 yes | yes | yes | yes
2983 Arguments : none
2984
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02002985 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
2986 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. Setting
2987 "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server
2988 side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on
2989 the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
2990 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
2991 resources, similarly to "option forceclose". It also permits non-keepalive
2992 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
2993 conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note that some servers do not
2994 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
2995 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
2996 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01002997
2998 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
2999 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3000 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3001 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01003002 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3003 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003004
3005 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3006 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003007 It is worth noting that "option forceclose" has precedence over "option
3008 http-server-close" and that combining "http-server-close" with "httpclose"
3009 basically achieve the same result as "forceclose".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003010
3011 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3012 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3013
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003014 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3015 "option httpclose" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01003016
3017
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003018option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003019no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003020 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
3021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3022 yes | yes | yes | no
3023 Arguments : none
3024
3025 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
3026 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
3027 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
3028 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
3029 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
3030 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
3031 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
3032
3033 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
3034 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
3035 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
3036 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
3037 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
3038 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
3039 request along its whole life.
3040
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01003041 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
3042 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
3043 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
3044 front of an existing proxy.
3045
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01003046 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
3047
3048 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
3049 http-server-close".
3050
3051
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01003052option httpchk
3053option httpchk <uri>
3054option httpchk <method> <uri>
3055option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
3056 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
3057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3058 yes | no | yes | yes
3059 Arguments :
3060 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
3061 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
3062 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
3063 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
3064 ones.
3065
3066 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
3067 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
3068 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
3069
3070 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
3071 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
3072 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
3073 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
3074 after "\r\n" following the version string.
3075
3076 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
3077 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
3078 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
3079 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
3080 the lack of any response.
3081
3082 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
3083
3084 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
3085 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
3086 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
3087
3088 Examples :
3089 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
3090 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
3091 backend https_relay
3092 mode tcp
3093 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
3094 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
3095
3096 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
3097 "http-check" and the "check", "port" and "inter" server options.
3098
3099
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003100option httpclose
3101no option httpclose
3102 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
3103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3104 yes | yes | yes | yes
3105 Arguments : none
3106
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003107 By default, when a client communicates with a server, HAProxy will only
3108 analyze, log, and process the first request of each connection. If "option
3109 httpclose" is set, it will check if a "Connection: close" header is already
3110 set in each direction, and will add one if missing. Each end should react to
3111 this by actively closing the TCP connection after each transfer, thus
3112 resulting in a switch to the HTTP close mode. Any "Connection" header
3113 different from "close" will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003114
3115 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003116 close the connection eventhough they reply "Connection: close". For this
3117 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
3118 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
3119 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
3120 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
3121 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003122
3123 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
3124 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
3125 If "option forceclose" is specified too, it has precedence over "httpclose".
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01003126 If "option http-server-close" is enabled at the same time as "httpclose", it
3127 basically achieves the same result as "option forceclose".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003128
3129 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3130 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3131
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02003132 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
3133 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003134
3135
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003136option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003137 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
3138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3139 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003140 Arguments :
3141 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
3142 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
3143 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
3144 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
3145 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003146
3147 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3148 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3149 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
3150 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
3151 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
3152 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
3153 ports.
3154
3155 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3156
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02003157 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3158 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
3159 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
3160 by default.
3161
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003162 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003163
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003164
3165option http_proxy
3166no option http_proxy
3167 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
3168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3169 yes | yes | yes | yes
3170 Arguments : none
3171
3172 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
3173 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
3174 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
3175 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
3176 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
3177
3178 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
3179 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
3180 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
3181 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
3182 needed to add "option http_close" to ensure that all requests will correctly
3183 be analyzed.
3184
3185 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3186 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3187
3188 Example :
3189 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
3190 backend direct_forward
3191 option httpclose
3192 option http_proxy
3193
3194 See also : "option httpclose"
3195
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003196
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003197option ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3198 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3199 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3200 no | yes | yes | yes
3201
3202 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3203 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3204 and running).
3205
3206 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3207 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3208 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
3209 oftenly don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
3210 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3211
3212 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3213 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3214
3215 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3216 "unless" condition is met.
3217
3218 See also : "option force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3219
3220
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02003221option independant-streams
3222no option independant-streams
3223 Enable or disable independant timeout processing for both directions
3224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3225 yes | yes | yes | yes
3226 Arguments : none
3227
3228 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
3229 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
3230 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
3231 receive data or not.
3232
3233 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
3234 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
3235 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
3236 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
3237 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
3238 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
3239 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
3240 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
3241 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
3242 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
3243 socket buffers.
3244
3245 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
3246 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
3247 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
3248 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
3249 slow lines, so use it with caution.
3250
3251 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout server"
3252
3253
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003254option ldap-check
3255 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
3256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3257 yes | no | yes | yes
3258 Arguments : none
3259
3260 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
3261 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
3262 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
3263 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
3264
3265 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
3266 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
3267
3268 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
3269 configure it.
3270
3271 Example :
3272 option ldap-check
3273
3274 See also : "option httpchk"
3275
3276
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02003277option log-health-checks
3278no option log-health-checks
3279 Enable or disable logging of health checks
3280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3281 yes | no | yes | yes
3282 Arguments : none
3283
3284 Enable health checks logging so it possible to check for example what
3285 was happening before a server crash. Failed health check are logged if
3286 server is UP and succeeded health checks if server is DOWN, so the amount
3287 of additional information is limited.
3288
3289 If health check logging is enabled no health check status is printed
3290 when servers is set up UP/DOWN/ENABLED/DISABLED.
3291
3292 See also: "log" and section 8 about logging.
3293
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003294
3295option log-separate-errors
3296no option log-separate-errors
3297 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
3298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3299 yes | yes | yes | no
3300 Arguments : none
3301
3302 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
3303 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
3304 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
3305 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
3306 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
3307 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
3308 provides very important information.
3309
3310 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
3311 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
3312 error logs.
3313
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003314 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003315 logging.
3316
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003317
3318option logasap
3319no option logasap
3320 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
3321 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3322 yes | yes | yes | no
3323 Arguments : none
3324
3325 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
3326 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
3327 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
3328 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
3329 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
3330 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
3331 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003332 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003333 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
3334 bytes are expected to be transferred.
3335
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003336 Examples :
3337 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
3338 mode http
3339 option httplog
3340 option logasap
3341 log 192.168.2.200 local3
3342
3343 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
3344 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
3345 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
3346 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
3347
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003348 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003349 logging.
3350
3351
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01003352option mysql-check
3353 Use Mysql health checks for server testing
3354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3355 yes | no | yes | yes
3356 Arguments : none
3357
3358 The check consists in parsing Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or Error
3359 packet, which is sent by MySQL server on connect. It is a basic but useful
3360 test which does not produce any logging on the server. However, it does not
3361 check database presence nor database consistency, nor user permission to
3362 access. To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
3363
3364 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
3365 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
3366 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3367 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3368 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
3369 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
3370
3371 See also: "option httpchk"
3372
3373
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003374option nolinger
3375no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003376 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003377 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3378 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003379 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003380
3381 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
3382 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
3383 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
3384 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
3385 connections.
3386
3387 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
3388 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
3389 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
3390 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
3391 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
3392 this too.
3393
3394 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
3395 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
3396 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
3397
3398 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
3399 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
3400 for servers.
3401
3402 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3403 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3404
3405
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003406option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
3407 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
3408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3409 yes | yes | yes | yes
3410 Arguments :
3411 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3412 matching <network>
3413 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
3414 header name.
3415
3416 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
3417 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
3418 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
3419 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
3420 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
3421 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
3422 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
3423 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
3424 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3425 possible that the client has already brought one.
3426
3427 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
3428 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
3429 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
3430 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
3431 header and requires different one.
3432
3433 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3434 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3435 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3436 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3437 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3438 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3439 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3440
3441 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
3442 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3443 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
3444 both are defined.
3445
3446 It is important to note that as long as HAProxy does not support keep-alive
3447 connections, only the first request of a connection will receive the header.
3448 For this reason, it is important to ensure that "option httpclose" is set
3449 when using this option.
3450
3451 Examples :
3452 # Original Destination address
3453 frontend www
3454 mode http
3455 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
3456
3457 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
3458 backend www
3459 mode http
3460 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
3461
3462 See also : "option httpclose"
3463
3464
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003465option persist
3466no option persist
3467 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
3468 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3469 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003470 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003471
3472 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
3473 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
3474 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
3475 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
3476 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
3477 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
3478 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
3479 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
3480 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
3481 redirected to another valid server.
3482
3483 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3484 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3485
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003486 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003487
3488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003489option redispatch
3490no option redispatch
3491 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
3492 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3493 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003494 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003495
3496 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
3497 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
3498 be able to access the service anymore.
3499
3500 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
3501 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
3502
3503 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
3504 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
3505 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003506
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003507 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
3508 "redisp" keywords.
3509
3510 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3511 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3512
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003513 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003514
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003515
3516option smtpchk
3517option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
3518 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
3519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3520 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003521 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003522 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
3523 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
3524 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
3525
3526 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
3527 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
3528 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
3529
3530 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
3531 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
3532 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
3533 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
3534 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
3535 dead server.
3536
3537 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
3538 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
3539 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
3540 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
3541
3542 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
3543 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
3544 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
3545 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
3546 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
3547
3548 Example :
3549 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
3550
3551 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
3552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01003553
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02003554option socket-stats
3555no option socket-stats
3556
3557 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
3558 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3559 yes | yes | yes | no
3560
3561 Arguments : none
3562
3563
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003564option splice-auto
3565no option splice-auto
3566 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
3567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3568 yes | yes | yes | yes
3569 Arguments : none
3570
3571 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3572 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
3573 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
3574 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003575 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01003576 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
3577 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
3578 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
3579 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3580
3581 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
3582 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
3583 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
3584 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
3585 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
3586 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
3587 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
3588 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
3589 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
3590 keyword.
3591
3592 Example :
3593 option splice-auto
3594
3595 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3596 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3597
3598 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
3599 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3600
3601
3602option splice-request
3603no option splice-request
3604 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
3605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3606 yes | yes | yes | yes
3607 Arguments : none
3608
3609 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3610 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3611 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3612 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3613 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3614 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3615
3616 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3617
3618 Example :
3619 option splice-request
3620
3621 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3622 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3623
3624 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
3625 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3626
3627
3628option splice-response
3629no option splice-response
3630 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
3631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3632 yes | yes | yes | yes
3633 Arguments : none
3634
3635 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
3636 will user kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
3637 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
3638 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
3639 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
3640 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
3641
3642 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
3643
3644 Example :
3645 option splice-response
3646
3647 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3648 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3649
3650 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
3651 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
3652
3653
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003654option srvtcpka
3655no option srvtcpka
3656 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
3657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3658 yes | no | yes | yes
3659 Arguments : none
3660
3661 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3662 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3663 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3664 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3665
3666 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3667 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3668 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3669 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3670
3671 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3672 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3673 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3674 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3675 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3676
3677 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3678
3679 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3680 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3681 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
3682
3683 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3684 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3685
3686 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
3687
3688
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01003689option ssl-hello-chk
3690 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
3691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3692 yes | no | yes | yes
3693 Arguments : none
3694
3695 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
3696 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
3697 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
3698 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
3699 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
3700 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
3701 hello message.
3702
3703 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
3704 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
3705 messages, which is appreciable.
3706
3707 See also: "option httpchk"
3708
3709
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003710option tcp-smart-accept
3711no option tcp-smart-accept
3712 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
3713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3714 yes | yes | yes | no
3715 Arguments : none
3716
3717 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
3718 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
3719 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
3720 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
3721 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
3722 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
3723
3724 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
3725 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
3726 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
3727 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
3728
3729 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
3730 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
3731 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
3732 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
3733
3734 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
3735 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
3736 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
3737
3738 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
3739 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
3740 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
3741
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02003742 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
3743
3744
3745option tcp-smart-connect
3746no option tcp-smart-connect
3747 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
3748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3749 yes | no | yes | yes
3750 Arguments : none
3751
3752 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
3753 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
3754 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
3755 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
3756 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
3757
3758 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
3759 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
3760 complex.
3761
3762 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
3763 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
3764 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
3765
3766 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3767 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3768
3769 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
3770
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02003771
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003772option tcpka
3773 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
3774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3775 yes | yes | yes | yes
3776 Arguments : none
3777
3778 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3779 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3780 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3781 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3782
3783 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3784 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3785 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3786 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3787
3788 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3789 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3790 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3791 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3792 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3793
3794 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3795
3796 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
3797 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
3798 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
3799 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
3800 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
3801 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
3802 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
3803 backends.
3804
3805 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
3806
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003807
3808option tcplog
3809 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
3810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3811 yes | yes | yes | yes
3812 Arguments : none
3813
3814 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
3815 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
3816 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
3817 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
3818 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
3819 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
3820 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
3821 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
3822
3823 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
3824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003825 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003826
3827
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003828option transparent
3829no option transparent
3830 Enable client-side transparent proxying
3831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01003832 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003833 Arguments : none
3834
3835 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
3836 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
3837 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
3838 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
3839 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
3840 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
3841 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
3842 appropriate server.
3843
3844 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
3845 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
3846
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01003847 See also: the "usersrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
3848 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01003849
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003850
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003851persist rdp-cookie
3852persist rdp-cookie(name)
3853 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
3854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3855 yes | no | yes | yes
3856 Arguments :
3857 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02003858 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
3859 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003860
3861 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
3862 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
3863 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
3864 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
3865 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
3866 forwarded to this server.
3867
3868 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
3869 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
3870 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003871 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003872 a single "listen" section.
3873
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02003874 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
3875 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
3876 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
3877
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02003878 Example :
3879 listen tse-farm
3880 bind :3389
3881 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
3882 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
3883 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
3884 # apply RDP cookie persistence
3885 persist rdp-cookie
3886 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
3887 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
3888 balance rdp-cookie
3889 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
3890 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
3891
3892 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
3893
3894
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01003895rate-limit sessions <rate>
3896 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
3897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3898 yes | yes | yes | no
3899 Arguments :
3900 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
3901 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
3902
3903 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
3904 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
3905 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
3906 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
3907 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
3908 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
3909
3910 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
3911 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
3912 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
3913 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
3914
3915 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
3916 listen smtp
3917 mode tcp
3918 bind :25
3919 rate-limit sessions 10
3920 server 127.0.0.1:1025
3921
3922 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status appears as
3923 "FULL" in the statistics, exactly as when it is saturated.
3924
3925 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
3926
3927
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01003928redirect location <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
3929redirect prefix <to> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02003930 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
3931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3932 no | yes | yes | yes
3933
3934 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01003935 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02003936
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003937 Arguments :
3938 <to> With "redirect location", the exact value in <to> is placed into
3939 the HTTP "Location" header. In case of "redirect prefix", the
3940 "Location" header is built from the concatenation of <to> and the
3941 complete URI, including the query string, unless the "drop-query"
Willy Tarreaufe651a52008-11-19 21:15:17 +01003942 option is specified (see below). As a special case, if <to>
3943 equals exactly "/" in prefix mode, then nothing is inserted
3944 before the original URI. It allows one to redirect to the same
3945 URL.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003946
3947 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
3948 is desired. Only codes 301, 302 and 303 are supported, and 302 is
3949 used if no code is specified. 301 means "Moved permanently", and
3950 a browser may cache the Location. 302 means "Moved permanently"
3951 and means that the browser should not cache the redirection. 303
3952 is equivalent to 302 except that the browser will fetch the
3953 location with a GET method.
3954
3955 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
3956 expected behaviour of a redirection :
3957
3958 - "drop-query"
3959 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
3960 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
3961 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
3962 with a location-type redirect.
3963
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01003964 - "append-slash"
3965 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
3966 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
3967 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
3968 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
3969
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003970 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
3971 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
3972 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
3973 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
3974 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
3975 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
3976 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
3977
3978 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
3979 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
3980 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
3981 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
3982 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
3983 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
3984 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02003985
3986 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
3987 acl clear dst_port 80
3988 acl secure dst_port 8080
3989 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003990 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01003991 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003992 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
3993
3994 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01003995 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
3996 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
3997 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01003998 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02003999
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01004000 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
4001 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
4002 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
4003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004004 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02004005
4006
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004007redisp (deprecated)
4008redispatch (deprecated)
4009 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4010 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4011 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004012 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004013
4014 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4015 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4016 be able to access the service anymore.
4017
4018 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
4019 redistribute them to a working server.
4020
4021 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4022 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4023 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004025 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
4026 "option redispatch" instead.
4027
4028 See also : "option redispatch"
4029
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004030
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004031reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004032 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
4033 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4034 no | yes | yes | yes
4035 Arguments :
4036 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4037 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004038 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004039
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004040 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4041 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4042
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004043 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4044 the last header of an HTTP request.
4045
4046 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4047 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4048 responses.
4049
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01004050 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
4051 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
4052 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
4053
4054 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4055 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004056
4057
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004058reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4059reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004060 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4062 no | yes | yes | yes
4063 Arguments :
4064 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4065 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4066 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4067 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4068 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4069 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
4070 ignores case.
4071
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004072 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4073 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4074
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004075 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4076 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
4077 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4078 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004079 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004080
4081 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4082 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4083
4084 Example :
4085 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
4086 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4087 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4088
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004089 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
4090 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004091
4092
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004093reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4094reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004095 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
4096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4097 no | yes | yes | yes
4098 Arguments :
4099 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4100 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4101 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4102 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4103 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
4104 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
4105
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004106 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4107 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4108
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004109 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
4110 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4111 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
4112 next servers.
4113
4114 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4115 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4116 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4117
4118 Example :
4119 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
4120 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
4121 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
4122
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004123 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4124 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004125
4126
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004127reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4128reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004129 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
4130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4131 no | yes | yes | yes
4132 Arguments :
4133 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4134 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4135 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4136 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4137 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4138 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
4139 case.
4140
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004141 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4142 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4143
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004144 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4145 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
4146 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
4147 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004148 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004149
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004150 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004151 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004152 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004153
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004154 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4155 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4156
4157 Example :
4158 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
4159 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4160 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4161
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004162 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4163 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004164
4165
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004166reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4167reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004168 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
4169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4170 no | yes | yes | yes
4171 Arguments :
4172 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4173 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4174 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4175 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4176 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4177 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
4178 case.
4179
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004180 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4181 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4182
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004183 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4184 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
4185 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
4186 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4187
4188 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4189 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
4190
4191 Example :
4192 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
4193 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
4194 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
4195 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
4196
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004197 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
4198 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004199
4200
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004201reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4202reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004203 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
4204 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4205 no | yes | yes | yes
4206 Arguments :
4207 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4208 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4209 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4210 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4211 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
4212 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
4213
4214 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4215 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4216 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4217 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004218 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004219
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004220 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4221 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4222
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004223 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
4224 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
4225 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
4226
4227 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4228 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4229 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4230 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
4231 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
4232
4233 Example :
4234 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
4235 reqrep ^([^\ ]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
4236 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
4237 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
4238
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004239 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", section 6 about HTTP header
4240 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004241
4242
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004243reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4244reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004245 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
4246 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4247 no | yes | yes | yes
4248 Arguments :
4249 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4250 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
4251 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
4252 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
4253 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
4254 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
4255 ignores case.
4256
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004257 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4258 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4259
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004260 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4261 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004262 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
4263 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
4264 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004265 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
4266 not set.
4267
4268 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
4269 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
4270 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
4271 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
4272 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
4273
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004274 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004275 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
4276 # block all others.
4277 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
4278 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
4279
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01004280 # block bad guys
4281 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
4282 reqitarpit . if badguys
4283
4284 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
4285 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004286
4287
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02004288retries <value>
4289 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
4290 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4291 yes | no | yes | yes
4292 Arguments :
4293 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
4294 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
4295 default value is 3.
4296
4297 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
4298 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
4299 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
4300
4301 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
4302 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
4303
4304 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
4305 server even if a cookie references a different server.
4306
4307 See also : "option redispatch"
4308
4309
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004310rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004311 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
4312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4313 no | yes | yes | yes
4314 Arguments :
4315 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4316 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004317 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004318
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004319 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4320 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4321
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004322 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
4323 the last header of an HTTP response.
4324
4325 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4326 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4327 responses.
4328
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004329 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
4330 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004331
4332
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004333rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4334rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004335 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
4336 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4337 no | yes | yes | yes
4338 Arguments :
4339 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4340 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4341 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4342 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4343 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4344 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
4345 ignores case.
4346
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004347 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4348 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4349
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004350 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
4351 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
4352 and/or sensible headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
4353 client.
4354
4355 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4356 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4357 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
4358
4359 Example :
4360 # remove the Server header from responses
4361 reqidel ^Server:.*
4362
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004363 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
4364 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004365
4366
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004367rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4368rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004369 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
4370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4371 no | yes | yes | yes
4372 Arguments :
4373 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4374 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4375 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4376 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4377 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4378 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
4379 ignores case.
4380
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004381 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4382 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4383
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004384 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
4385 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
4386 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
4387 case-sensitive.
4388
4389 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01004390 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
4391 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
4392 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004393
4394 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
4395 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
4396
4397 Example :
4398 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
4399 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
4400
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004401 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
4402 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004403
4404
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004405rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
4406rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004407 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
4408 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4409 no | yes | yes | yes
4410 Arguments :
4411 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
4412 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
4413 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
4414 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
4415 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
4416 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
4417 ignores case.
4418
4419 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
4420 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
4421 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
4422 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004423 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004424
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004425 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
4426 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
4427
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004428 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
4429 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
4430 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
4431
4432 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
4433 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
4434 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
4435 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
4436 are not case-sensitive.
4437
4438 Example :
4439 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
4440 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
4441
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01004442 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
4443 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01004444
4445
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004446server <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
4447 Declare a server in a backend
4448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4449 no | no | yes | yes
4450 Arguments :
4451 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
4452 appear in logs and alerts.
4453
4454 <address> is the IPv4 address of the server. Alternatively, a resolvable
4455 hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved during
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02004456 start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning. It
4457 indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
4458 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
4459 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
4460 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
4461 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
4462 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
4463 to report statistics.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004464
4465 <ports> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
4466 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
4467 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
4468 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
4469 adding this value to the client's port.
4470
4471 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
4472 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004473 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004474
4475 Examples :
4476 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
4477 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
4478
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004479 See also: "default-server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004480
4481
4482source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004483source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004484source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004485 Set the source address for outgoing connections
4486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4487 yes | no | yes | yes
4488 Arguments :
4489 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
4490 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
4491 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
4492 the most appropriate address to reach its destination.
4493
4494 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
4495 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02004496 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
4497 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
4498 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004499
4500 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
4501 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
4502 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
4503 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
4504 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
4505 <addr>.
4506
4507 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
4508 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
4509 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
4510 port.
4511
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004512 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
4513 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
4514 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
4515 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
4516 and to automatically bind to the the client's IP address as seen
4517 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
4518 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
4519 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
4520 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
4521 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
4522 HTTP header.
4523
4524 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
4525 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
4526 in order to specificy which occurrence to use for the source IP
4527 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
4528 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
4529 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
4530 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
4531 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
4532 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
4533 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
4534
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01004535 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
4536 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
4537 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
4538 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
4539 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
4540 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
4541
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004542 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
4543 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
4544 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
4545 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
4546
4547 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
4548 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
4549 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
4550 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
4551 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
4552 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
4553
4554 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
4555 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
4556 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
4557 there are two methods :
4558
4559 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
4560 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
4561 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
4562 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
4563 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
4564 of the client ranges may be used.
4565
4566 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
4567 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
4568 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
4569 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
4570 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
4571 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
4572 same session.
4573
4574 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
4575 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
4576 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
4577 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
4578 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
4579 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
4580
4581 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
4582 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
4583 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004584 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004585
4586 Examples :
4587 backend private
4588 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
4589 source 192.168.1.200
4590
4591 backend transparent_ssl1
4592 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
4593 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4594
4595 backend transparent_ssl2
4596 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
4597 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
4598 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
4599
4600 backend transparent_ssl3
4601 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
4602 # is more conntrack-friendly.
4603 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
4604
4605 backend transparent_smtp
4606 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
4607 # with Tproxy version 4.
4608 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
4609
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02004610 backend transparent_http
4611 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
4612 # proxy.
4613 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
4614
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004615 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004616 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
4617
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004618
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004619srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
4620 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
4621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4622 yes | no | yes | yes
4623 Arguments :
4624 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4625 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4626 as explained at the top of this document.
4627
4628 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
4629 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
4630 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
4631 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
4632 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
4633 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
4634 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
4635
4636 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
4637 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
4638 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
4639 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
4640 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004641 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004642 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004643 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01004644
4645 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
4646 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
4647 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
4648 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
4649 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
4650 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
4651
4652 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
4653 Please use "timeout server" instead.
4654
4655 See also : "timeout server", "timeout client" and "clitimeout".
4656
4657
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004658stats auth <user>:<passwd>
4659 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
4660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4661 yes | no | yes | yes
4662 Arguments :
4663 <user> is a user name to grant access to
4664
4665 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
4666
4667 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
4668 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
4669 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
4670 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
4671 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
4672 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
4673
4674 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
4675 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
4676 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
4677 that those ones should not be sensible and not shared with any other account.
4678
4679 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
4680 report using "stats scope".
4681
4682 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4683 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4684 unobvious parameters.
4685
4686 Example :
4687 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4688 backend public_www
4689 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4690 stats enable
4691 stats hide-version
4692 stats scope .
4693 stats uri /admin?stats
4694 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4695 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4696 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4697
4698 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4699 backend private_monitoring
4700 stats enable
4701 stats uri /admin?stats
4702 stats refresh 5s
4703
4704 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
4705
4706
4707stats enable
4708 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
4709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4710 yes | no | yes | yes
4711 Arguments : none
4712
4713 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
4714 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
4715 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
4716 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
4717 - stats auth : no authentication
4718 - stats scope : no restriction
4719
4720 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4721 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4722 unobvious parameters.
4723
4724 Example :
4725 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4726 backend public_www
4727 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4728 stats enable
4729 stats hide-version
4730 stats scope .
4731 stats uri /admin?stats
4732 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4733 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4734 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4735
4736 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4737 backend private_monitoring
4738 stats enable
4739 stats uri /admin?stats
4740 stats refresh 5s
4741
4742 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4743
4744
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004745stats hide-version
4746 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004747 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4748 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004749 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004750
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004751 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
4752 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
4753 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
4754 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
4755 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
4756 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004757
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004758 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4759 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4760 unobvious parameters.
4761
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004762 Example :
4763 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4764 backend public_www
4765 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02004766 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004767 stats hide-version
4768 stats scope .
4769 stats uri /admin?stats
4770 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4771 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4772 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004773
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004774 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4775 backend private_monitoring
4776 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004777 stats uri /admin?stats
4778 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01004779
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004780 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02004781
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004782
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004783stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
4784 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4785 Access control for statistics
4786
4787 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4788 no | no | yes | yes
4789
4790 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
4791 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
4792 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
4793 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
4794 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
4795 should be asked to enter a username and password.
4796
4797 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
4798 instance.
4799
4800 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4801 about ACL usage.
4802
4803
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004804stats realm <realm>
4805 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
4806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4807 yes | no | yes | yes
4808 Arguments :
4809 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
4810 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
4811 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
4812
4813 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
4814 using a backslash ('\').
4815
4816 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
4817 only related to authentication.
4818
4819 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4820 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4821 unobvious parameters.
4822
4823 Example :
4824 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4825 backend public_www
4826 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4827 stats enable
4828 stats hide-version
4829 stats scope .
4830 stats uri /admin?stats
4831 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4832 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4833 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4834
4835 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4836 backend private_monitoring
4837 stats enable
4838 stats uri /admin?stats
4839 stats refresh 5s
4840
4841 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
4842
4843
4844stats refresh <delay>
4845 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
4846 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4847 yes | no | yes | yes
4848 Arguments :
4849 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
4850 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
4851 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
4852 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
4853 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
4854 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
4855
4856 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
4857 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
4858 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
4859 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
4860
4861 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4862 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4863 unobvious parameters.
4864
4865 Example :
4866 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4867 backend public_www
4868 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4869 stats enable
4870 stats hide-version
4871 stats scope .
4872 stats uri /admin?stats
4873 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4874 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4875 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4876
4877 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4878 backend private_monitoring
4879 stats enable
4880 stats uri /admin?stats
4881 stats refresh 5s
4882
4883 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4884
4885
4886stats scope { <name> | "." }
4887 Enable statistics and limit access scope
4888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4889 yes | no | yes | yes
4890 Arguments :
4891 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
4892 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
4893 section in which the statement appears.
4894
4895 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
4896 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
4897 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
4898 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
4899 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
4900 exists.
4901
4902 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4903 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4904 unobvious parameters.
4905
4906 Example :
4907 # public access (limited to this backend only)
4908 backend public_www
4909 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4910 stats enable
4911 stats hide-version
4912 stats scope .
4913 stats uri /admin?stats
4914 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
4915 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
4916 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
4917
4918 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4919 backend private_monitoring
4920 stats enable
4921 stats uri /admin?stats
4922 stats refresh 5s
4923
4924 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
4925
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004926
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02004927stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004928 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
4929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4930 yes | no | yes | yes
4931
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02004932 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004933 description from global section is automatically used instead.
4934
4935 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
4936 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
4937
4938 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4939 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4940 unobvious parameters.
4941
4942 Example :
4943 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4944 backend private_monitoring
4945 stats enable
4946 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
4947 stats uri /admin?stats
4948 stats refresh 5s
4949
4950 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
4951 global section.
4952
4953
4954stats show-legends
4955 Enable reporting additional informations on the statistics page :
4956 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
4957 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
4958 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
4959 - IP (socket, server)
4960 - cookie (backend, server)
4961
4962 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4963 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4964 unobvious parameters.
4965
4966 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
4967
4968
4969stats show-node [ <name> ]
4970 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
4971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4972 yes | no | yes | yes
4973 Arguments:
4974 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
4975 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
4976
4977 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
4978 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
4979 provided for each customer.
4980
4981 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
4982 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
4983 unobvious parameters.
4984
4985 Example:
4986 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
4987 backend private_monitoring
4988 stats enable
4989 stats show-node Europe-1
4990 stats uri /admin?stats
4991 stats refresh 5s
4992
4993 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
4994 section.
4995
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004996
4997stats uri <prefix>
4998 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
4999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5000 yes | no | yes | yes
5001 Arguments :
5002 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
5003 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
5004 query string.
5005
5006 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
5007 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
5008 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
5009 possible to reach it in the application.
5010
5011 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005012 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005013 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
5014 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
5015 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
5016 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
5017
5018 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
5019 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
5020 an address or a port to statistics only.
5021
5022 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
5023 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
5024 unobvious parameters.
5025
5026 Example :
5027 # public access (limited to this backend only)
5028 backend public_www
5029 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5030 stats enable
5031 stats hide-version
5032 stats scope .
5033 stats uri /admin?stats
5034 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
5035 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
5036 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
5037
5038 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
5039 backend private_monitoring
5040 stats enable
5041 stats uri /admin?stats
5042 stats refresh 5s
5043
5044 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
5045
5046
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005047stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
5048 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005050 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005051
5052 Arguments :
5053 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5054 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5055 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
5056 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
5057
5058 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5059 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5060 the "stick-table" statement.
5061
5062 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
5063 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
5064 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
5065 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
5066 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
5067
5068 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5069 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
5070 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
5071 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
5072 transformation rules.
5073
5074 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5075 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5076 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5077 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5078 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5079 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5080 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5081
5082 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
5083 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
5084 ACL based conditions.
5085
5086 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
5087 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
5088 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
5089 matches can be used as fallbacks.
5090
5091 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
5092 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
5093 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
5094 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
5095
5096 Example :
5097 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5098 # last 30 minutes
5099 backend pop
5100 mode tcp
5101 balance roundrobin
5102 stick store-request src
5103 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5104 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5105 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5106
5107 backend smtp
5108 mode tcp
5109 balance roundrobin
5110 stick match src table pop
5111 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5112 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5113
5114 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5115 extraction.
5116
5117
5118stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5119 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
5120 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5121 no | no | yes | yes
5122
5123 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
5124 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
5125 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
5126 for writing more maintainable configurations.
5127
5128 Examples :
5129 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01005130 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005131
5132 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
5133 stick match src table pop if !localhost
5134 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
5135
5136
5137 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
5138 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
5139 backend http
5140 mode http
5141 balance roundrobin
5142 stick on src table https
5143 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5144 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
5145 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
5146
5147 backend https
5148 mode tcp
5149 balance roundrobin
5150 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5151 stick on src
5152 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
5153 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
5154
5155 See also : "stick match" and "stick store-request"
5156
5157
5158stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
5159 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
5160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5161 no | no | yes | yes
5162
5163 Arguments :
5164 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.8. It
5165 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
5166 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
5167 server is selected.
5168
5169 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
5170 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
5171 the "stick-table" statement.
5172
5173 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
5174 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
5175 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
5176 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
5177 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
5178 address.
5179
5180 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
5181 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
5182 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
5183 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
5184 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
5185 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
5186 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
5187 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
5188 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
5189 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
5190
5191 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
5192 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
5193 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
5194 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
5195 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
5196 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
5197 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
5198
5199 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
5200 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
5201 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
5202 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
5203
5204 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
5205 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
5206 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
5207 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
5208 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
5209 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
5210 another protocol or access method.
5211
5212 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
5213 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
5214 the request.
5215
5216 Example :
5217 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
5218 # last 30 minutes
5219 backend pop
5220 mode tcp
5221 balance roundrobin
5222 stick store-request src
5223 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
5224 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
5225 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
5226
5227 backend smtp
5228 mode tcp
5229 balance roundrobin
5230 stick match src table pop
5231 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
5232 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
5233
5234 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
5235 extraction.
5236
5237
5238stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] } size <size>
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005239 [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005240 Configure the stickiness table for the current backend
5241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005242 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005243
5244 Arguments :
5245 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
5246 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
5247 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
5248 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
5249
5250 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
5251 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
5252 instance.
5253
5254 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
5255 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
5256 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
5257 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
5258 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
5259 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
5260 to 31 characters.
5261
5262 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
5263 "string" type table. See type "string" above. Be careful when
5264 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
5265 increase.
5266
5267 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005268 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
5269 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
5270 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005271
5272 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
5273 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
5274 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
5275 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
5276 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
5277 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
5278 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
5279 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
5280 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
5281 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
5282 parameter (see below).
5283
5284 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
5285 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
5286 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
5287 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
5288 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
5289 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
5290 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
5291 if not expiration delay is specified.
5292
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005293 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
5294 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
5295 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
5296 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005297 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
5298 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
5299 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
5300 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
5301 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
5302 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
5303 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
5304 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
5305 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
5306 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
5307 types and their arguments.
5308
5309 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
5310 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
5311 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
5312 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
5313
5314 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
5315 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
5316 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
5317 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
5318
5319 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5320 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
5321 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
5322 they were received.
5323
5324 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5325 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
5326 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
5327 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
5328 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
5329
5330 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5331 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5332 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5333 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
5334 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5335
5336 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
5337 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
5338 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
5339
5340 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5341 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5342 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5343 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
5344 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5345
5346 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5347 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
5348 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
5349 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
5350 the client side.
5351
5352 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5353 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5354 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5355 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
5356 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
5357 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
5358 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
5359
5360 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
5361 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
5362 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
5363 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
5364 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
5365 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
5366 (eg: vulnerability scan).
5367
5368 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5369 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5370 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5371 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
5372 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
5373 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
5374
5375 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5376 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
5377 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
5378 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
5379
5380 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
5381 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5382 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5383 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5384 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5385 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
5386 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
5387 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
5388 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
5389 recommended for better fairness.
5390
5391 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
5392 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
5393 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
5394 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
5395
5396 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
5397 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
5398 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
5399 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
5400 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
5401 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
5402 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
5403 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
5404 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
5405 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02005406
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02005407 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
5408 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005409 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
5410 reference it.
5411
5412 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
5413 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
5414 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
5415 as an exclusive stickiness.
5416
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02005417 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
5418 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
5419 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
5420 something that can be ignored.
5421
5422 Example:
5423 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
5424 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
5425 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
5426 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
5427
5428 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
5429 about time format and section 7 avoud ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01005430
5431
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005432tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5433 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5435 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005436 Arguments :
5437 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5438 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5439 See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02005440
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005441 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005442
5443 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
5444 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005445 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
5446 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
5447 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
5448 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
5449 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
5450 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005451
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005452 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
5453 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
5454 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
5455 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005456
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005457 Three types of actions are supported :
5458 - accept :
5459 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5460 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5461 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005462
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005463 - reject :
5464 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
5465 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
5466 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
5467 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
5468 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
5469 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
5470 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
5471 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
5472 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
5473 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
5474 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
5475 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005476
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005477 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
5478 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
5479 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
5480 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
5481 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
5482 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
5483 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
5484 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
5485 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005486
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005487 These actions take one or two arguments :
5488 <key> is mandatory, and defines the criterion the tracking key will
5489 be derived from. At the moment, only "src" is supported. With
5490 it, the key will be the connection's source IPv4 address.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005491
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005492 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
5493 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
5494 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
5495 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005496
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005497 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
5498 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
5499 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
5500 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
5501 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
5502 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
5503 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
5504 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
5505 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
5506 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005507
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005508 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
5509 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5510 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005511
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005512 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
5513 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
5514 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005515
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005516 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005517 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005518 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005519
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005520 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
5521 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
5522 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005523
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005524 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
5525 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5526 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005527
5528 See section 7 about ACL usage.
5529
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005530 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005531
5532
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005533tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5534 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005536 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005537 Arguments :
5538 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
5539 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc1", "track-sc2".
5540 See "tcp-request connection" above for their signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005541
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005542 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005543
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005544 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
5545 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
5546 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
5547 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
5548 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005549
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005550 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
5551 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
5552 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
5553 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
5554 both frontends and backends. In frontends, they will be evaluated upon new
5555 connections. In backends, they will be evaluated once a session is assigned
5556 a backend. This means that a single frontend connection may be evaluated
5557 several times by one or multiple backends when a session gets reassigned
5558 (for instance after a client-side HTTP keep-alive request).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005559
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005560 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
5561 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
5562 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
5563 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005564
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005565 Three types of actions are supported :
5566 - accept :
5567 - reject :
5568 - { track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005569
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005570 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
5571 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005572
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005573 Also, it is worth noting that if sticky counters are tracked from a rule
5574 defined in a backend, this tracking will automatically end when the session
5575 releases the backend. That allows per-backend counter tracking even in case
5576 of HTTP keep-alive requests when the backend changes. While there is nothing
5577 mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the track-sc1 pointer to track
5578 per-frontend counters and track-sc2 to track per-backend counters.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005579
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005580 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005581 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
5582 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005583
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005584 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
5585 rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full request has been
5586 buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this, the
5587 best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
5588 period.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005589
5590 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005591 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
5592 # and reject everything else.
5593 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
5594 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5595 tcp-request content accept if HTTP is_host_com
5596 tcp-request content reject
5597
5598 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005599 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
5600 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5601 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005602 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005603
5604 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
5605 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
5606 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02005607 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005608 tcp-request content reject
5609
5610 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
5611 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
5612
5613 frontend http
5614 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC1 as a global abuse counter
5615 # protecting all our sites
5616 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
5617 tcp-request connection track-sc1 src
5618 tcp-request connection reject if { sc1_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
5619 ...
5620 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
5621
5622 backend http_dynamic
5623 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
5624 # by SC2), block it globally in the frontend.
5625 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
5626 acl click_too_fast sc2_http_req_rate gt 10
5627 acl mark_as_abuser sc1_inc_gpc0
5628 tcp-request content track-sc2 src
5629 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005630
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005631 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005632
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02005633 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005634
5635
5636tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
5637 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
5638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005639 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005640 Arguments :
5641 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5642 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5643 as explained at the top of this document.
5644
5645 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
5646 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
5647 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
5648 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
5649 data for at most the specified amount of time.
5650
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02005651 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
5652 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
5653 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
5654 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
5655
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005656 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
5657 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005658 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005659 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01005660 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
5661 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
5662 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
5663 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005664
5665 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
5666 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
5667 it pass through unaffected.
5668
5669 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
5670 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
5671 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005672 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005673 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
5674 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02005675 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
5676 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
5677 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005678
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005679 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02005680 "timeout client".
5681
5682
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005683timeout check <timeout>
5684 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
5685 established.
5686
5687 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5688 yes | no | yes | yes
5689 Arguments:
5690 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5691 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5692 as explained at the top of this document.
5693
5694 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
5695 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
5696 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
5697 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01005698 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
5699 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
5700 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005701
5702 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
5703 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
5704
5705 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
5706 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01005707 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005708
5709 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5710 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5711 forget about it.
5712
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01005713 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
5714 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005715
5716
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005717timeout client <timeout>
5718timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5719 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
5720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5721 yes | yes | yes | no
5722 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005723 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005724 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5725 as explained at the top of this document.
5726
5727 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
5728 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5729 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
5730 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
5731 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
5732 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
5733 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
5734 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005735 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005736 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
5737 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
5738
5739 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
5740 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5741 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5742 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5743 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5744 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5745
5746 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
5747 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
5748 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
5749
5750 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server".
5751
5752
5753timeout connect <timeout>
5754timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5755 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
5756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5757 yes | no | yes | yes
5758 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005759 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005760 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5761 as explained at the top of this document.
5762
5763 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005764 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005765 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005766 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01005767 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
5768 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005769
5770 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5771 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5772 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5773 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5774 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
5775 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5776
5777 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
5778 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
5779 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
5780
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01005781 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
5782 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005783
5784
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005785timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
5786 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
5787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5788 yes | yes | yes | yes
5789 Arguments :
5790 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5791 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5792 as explained at the top of this document.
5793
5794 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
5795 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
5796 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
5797 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
5798 once the request has started to present itself.
5799
5800 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
5801 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
5802 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
5803 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
5804 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
5805
5806 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
5807 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
5808 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
5809 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
5810
5811 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
5812 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
5813 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
5814 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
5815 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02005816 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005817
5818 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
5819 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
5820 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
5821 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
5822
5823 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
5824
5825
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005826timeout http-request <timeout>
5827 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
5828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02005829 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005830 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005831 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005832 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5833 as explained at the top of this document.
5834
5835 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
5836 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
5837 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
5838 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
5839 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
5840 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
5841 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
5842 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time.
5843
5844 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
5845 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005846 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
5847 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005848
5849 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
5850 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
5851 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
5852 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
5853 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
5854
5855 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02005856 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
5857 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
5858 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005859
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005860 See also : "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01005861
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005862
5863timeout queue <timeout>
5864 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
5865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5866 yes | no | yes | yes
5867 Arguments :
5868 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5869 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5870 as explained at the top of this document.
5871
5872 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
5873 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
5874 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
5875 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
5876 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
5877
5878 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
5879 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
5880 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
5881 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
5882
5883 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
5884
5885
5886timeout server <timeout>
5887timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5888 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5890 yes | no | yes | yes
5891 Arguments :
5892 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5893 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5894 as explained at the top of this document.
5895
5896 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5897 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5898 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5899 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5900 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5901 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5902 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5903
5904 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5905 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5906 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5907 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5908 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005909 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005910 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005911 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005912
5913 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5914 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5915 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5916 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5917 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5918 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5919
5920 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
5921 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
5922 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
5923
5924 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client".
5925
5926
5927timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005928 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5930 yes | yes | yes | yes
5931 Arguments :
5932 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
5933 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5934 as explained at the top of this document.
5935
5936 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
5937 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
5938 defines how long it will be maintained open.
5939
5940 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5941 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5942 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
5943 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005944 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005945
5946 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
5947
5948
5949transparent (deprecated)
5950 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005952 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005953 Arguments : none
5954
5955 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
5956 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5957 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5958 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5959 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5960 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5961 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5962 appropriate server.
5963
5964 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
5965
5966 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5967 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5968
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005969 See also: "option transparent"
5970
5971
5972use_backend <backend> if <condition>
5973use_backend <backend> unless <condition>
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02005974 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5976 no | yes | yes | no
5977 Arguments :
5978 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section.
5979
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005980 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005981
5982 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
5983 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
5984 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02005985 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
5986 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
5987 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
5988 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005989
5990 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
5991 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
5992 assign the backend.
5993
5994 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
5995 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
5996 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
5997 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
5998 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
5999 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
6000
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006001 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006002 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02006003 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
6004 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
6005 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
6006
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02006007 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006008
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01006009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010060105. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006011------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006012
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006013The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
6014which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
6015arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
6016settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
6017after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
6018Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
6019address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006020
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006021 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01006022 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006023
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006024The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006025
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006026addr <ipv4>
6027 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
6028 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
6029 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
6030 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
6031 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006032
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006033 Supported in default-server: No
6034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006035backup
6036 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
6037 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
6038 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
6039 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
6040 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
6041 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006042
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006043 Supported in default-server: No
6044
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006045check
6046 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
6047 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server will receive
6048 periodic health checks to ensure that it is really able to serve requests.
6049 The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the server,
6050 and the default source is the same as the one defined in the backend. It is
6051 possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the port using the
6052 "port" parameter, the source address using the "source" address, and the
6053 interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall" parameters. The
6054 request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk", "smtpchk",
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006055 "mysql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please refer to those options and
6056 parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006057
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006058 Supported in default-server: No
6059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006060cookie <value>
6061 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
6062 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
6063 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
6064 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
6065 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
6066 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
6067 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
6068
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006069 Supported in default-server: No
6070
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02006071disabled
6072 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
6073 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
6074 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
6075 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
6076 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
6077
6078 Supported in default-server: No
6079
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006080error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006081 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
6082 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
6083 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006085 Supported in default-server: Yes
6086
6087 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006088
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006089fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006090 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
6091 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
6092 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
6093
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006094 Supported in default-server: Yes
6095
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006096id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006097 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
6098 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
6099 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006100
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006101 Supported in default-server: No
6102
6103inter <delay>
6104fastinter <delay>
6105downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006106 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
6107 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
6108 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
6109 between checks depending on the server state :
6110
6111 Server state | Interval used
6112 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6113 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
6114 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6115 Transitionally UP (going down), |
6116 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6117 or yet unchecked. |
6118 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
6119 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
6120 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006122 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
6123 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
6124 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
6125 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
6126 hosted on the same hardware, the health-checks of all servers are started
6127 with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to add some random
6128 noise in the health checks interval using the global "spread-checks"
6129 keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot of backends use the same
6130 servers.
6131
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006132 Supported in default-server: Yes
6133
6134maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006135 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
6136 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
6137 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
6138 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
6139 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
6140 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
6141 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
6142 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
6143
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006144 Supported in default-server: Yes
6145
6146maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006147 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
6148 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
6149 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
6150 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
6151 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
6152 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
6153 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
6154
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006155 Supported in default-server: Yes
6156
6157minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006158 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
6159 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
6160 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
6161 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
6162 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
6163 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006164 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006165 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006166
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006167 Supported in default-server: Yes
6168
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006169observe <mode>
6170 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
6171 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
6172 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
6173 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
6174 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
6175 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
6176 headers, a timeout, etc.
6177
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006178 Supported in default-server: No
6179
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006180 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
6181
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006182on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006183 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
6184 Currently, four modes are available:
6185 - fastinter: force fastinter
6186 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
6187 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
6188 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
6189 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
6190
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006191 Supported in default-server: Yes
6192
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01006193 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
6194
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006195port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006196 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
6197 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
6198 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
6199 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
6200 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
6201 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
6202
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006203 Supported in default-server: Yes
6204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006205redir <prefix>
6206 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
6207 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
6208 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
6209 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
6210 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
6211 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
6212 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
6213 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006214 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006215 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
6216 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
6217 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
6218 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
6219 loop between the client and HAProxy!
6220
6221 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
6222
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006223 Supported in default-server: No
6224
6225rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006226 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
6227 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
6228 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
6229
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006230 Supported in default-server: Yes
6231
6232slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006233 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
6234 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
6235 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
6236 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
6237 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
6238 parameters :
6239
6240 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
6241 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
6242
6243 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
6244 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
6245 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
6246 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
6247
6248 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
6249 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
6250 seen as failed.
6251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006252 Supported in default-server: Yes
6253
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006254source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02006255source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006256source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006257 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
6258 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
6259 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
6260 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
6261
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02006262 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
6263 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
6264 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
6265 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
6266 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
6267 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
6268 server.
6269
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006270 Supported in default-server: No
6271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006272track [<proxy>/]<server>
6273 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by
6274 tracking another one. Only a server with checks enabled can be tracked
6275 so it is not possible for example to track a server that tracks another
6276 one. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
6277 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
6278
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006279 Supported in default-server: No
6280
6281weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006282 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
6283 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
6284 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02006285 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
6286 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
6287 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
6288 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
6289 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
6290 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006291
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01006292 Supported in default-server: Yes
6293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006294
62956. HTTP header manipulation
6296---------------------------
6297
6298In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
6299response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
6300request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
6301which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
6302against information leak from the internal network. But there is a limitation
6303to this : since HAProxy's HTTP engine does not support keep-alive, only headers
6304passed during the first request of a TCP session will be seen. All subsequent
6305headers will be considered data only and not analyzed. Furthermore, HAProxy
6306never touches data contents, it stops analysis at the end of headers.
6307
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006308There is an exception though. If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response"
6309(status code 1xx), it is able to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny,
6310rewrite or delete a header, but it will refuse to add a header to any such
6311messages as this is not HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers
6312in such responses is to stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006313happen, for instance because another downstream equipment would unconditionally
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02006314add a header, or if a server name appears there. When such messages are seen,
6315normal processing still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
6316
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006317This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
6318in section 4.2 :
6319
6320 - reqadd <string>
6321 - reqallow <search>
6322 - reqiallow <search>
6323 - reqdel <search>
6324 - reqidel <search>
6325 - reqdeny <search>
6326 - reqideny <search>
6327 - reqpass <search>
6328 - reqipass <search>
6329 - reqrep <search> <replace>
6330 - reqirep <search> <replace>
6331 - reqtarpit <search>
6332 - reqitarpit <search>
6333 - rspadd <string>
6334 - rspdel <search>
6335 - rspidel <search>
6336 - rspdeny <search>
6337 - rspideny <search>
6338 - rsprep <search> <replace>
6339 - rspirep <search> <replace>
6340
6341With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
6342is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
6343parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
6344prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
6345Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
6346
6347 \t for a tab
6348 \r for a carriage return (CR)
6349 \n for a new line (LF)
6350 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
6351 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
6352 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
6353 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
6354 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
6355
6356The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
6357portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
6358above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
6359regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
63609 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
6361is very common to users of the "sed" program.
6362
6363The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
6364after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
6365
6366Notes related to these keywords :
6367---------------------------------
6368 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
6369 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
6370 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
6371
6372 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
6373 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
6374 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
6375
6376 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
6377 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
6378 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
6379 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
6380 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
6381
6382 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
6383 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
6384 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
6385 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
6386 useless headers before adding new ones.
6387
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006388 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006389 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
6390
6391 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
6392 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
6393 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
6394
6395 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
6396 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006397 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006398
6399
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010064007. Using ACLs and pattern extraction
6401------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006402
6403The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
6404content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
6405from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
6406simple :
6407
6408 - define test criteria with sets of values
6409 - perform actions only if a set of tests is valid
6410
6411The actions generally consist in blocking the request, or selecting a backend.
6412
6413In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
6414
6415 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
6416
6417This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
6418Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
6419and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
6420an operator which may be specified before the set of values. The values are
6421of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
6422
6423ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
6424'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
6425which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
6426
6427There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
6428performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
6429
6430The following ACL flags are currently supported :
6431
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006432 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
6433 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006434 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
6435
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006436The "-f" flag is special as it loads all of the lines it finds in the file
6437specified in argument and loads all of them before continuing. It is even
6438possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments if the patterns are to be loaded from
Willy Tarreau58215a02010-05-13 22:07:43 +02006439multiple files. Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will
6440be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs will be stripped. If it is absolutely
6441needed to insert a valid pattern beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a
6442space so that it is not taken for a comment. Depending on the data type and
6443match method, haproxy may load the lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast
6444lookups. This is true for IPv4 and exact string matching. In this case,
6445duplicates will automatically be removed. Also, note that the "-i" flag applies
6446to subsequent entries and not to entries loaded from files preceeding it. For
6447instance :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02006448
6449 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
6450
6451In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
6452the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
6453case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
6454too.
6455
6456Note that right now it is difficult for the ACL parsers to report errors, so if
6457a file is unreadable or unparsable, the most you'll get is a parse error in the
6458ACL. Thus, file-based ACLs should only be produced by reliable processes.
6459
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006460Supported types of values are :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006461
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006462 - integers or integer ranges
6463 - strings
6464 - regular expressions
6465 - IP addresses and networks
6466
6467
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020064687.1. Matching integers
6469----------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006470
6471Matching integers is special in that ranges and operators are permitted. Note
6472that integer matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value
6473expressed with a lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which
6474may be omitted.
6475
6476For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
6477unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
6478representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
6479
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006480As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
6481two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
6482instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
6483ranges and operators.
6484
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006485For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006486operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
6487Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
6488of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006489
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006490Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006491
6492 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
6493 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
6494 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
6495 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
6496 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
6497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006498For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006499
6500 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
6501
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006502This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
6503
6504 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
6505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065077.2. Matching strings
6508---------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006509
6510String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
6511exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
6512characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
6513string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
6514to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006515before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006516
6517
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065187.3. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
6519-------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006520
6521Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
6522they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
6523possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
6524passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
6525the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006526the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
6527match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006528
6529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065307.4. Matching IPv4 addresses
6531----------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006532
6533IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
6534netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
6535within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006536host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006537difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
6538at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
6539does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
6540parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006541
6542
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065437.5. Available matching criteria
6544--------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065467.5.1. Matching at Layer 4 and below
6547------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006548
6549A first set of criteria applies to information which does not require any
6550analysis of the request or response contents. Those generally include TCP/IP
6551addresses and ports, as well as internal values independant on the stream.
6552
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006553always_false
6554 This one never matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6555 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6556
6557always_true
6558 This one always matches. All values and flags are ignored. It may be used as
6559 a temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
6560
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006561avg_queue <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006562avg_queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006563 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
6564 divided by the number of active servers. This is very similar to "queue"
6565 except that the size of the farm is considered, in order to give a more
6566 accurate measurement of the time it may take for a new connection to be
6567 processed. The main usage is to return a sorry page to new users when it
6568 becomes certain they will get a degraded service. Note that in the event
6569 there would not be any active server anymore, we would consider twice the
6570 number of queued connections as the measured value. This is a fair estimate,
6571 as we expect one server to get back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send
6572 new traffic to another backend if in better shape. See also the "queue",
6573 "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01006574
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006575be_conn <integer>
Willy Tarreau6cbd6472010-09-08 19:06:18 +02006576be_conn(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006577 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
6578 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
6579 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
6580 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
6581 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006582
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006583be_sess_rate <integer>
6584be_sess_rate(backend) <integer>
6585 Returns true when the sessions creation rate on the backend matches the
6586 specified values or ranges, in number of new sessions per second. This is
6587 used to switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one
6588 reaches too high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent
6589 sucking of an online dictionary).
6590
6591 Example :
6592 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
6593 backend dynamic
6594 mode http
6595 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
6596 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006597
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006598connslots <integer>
6599connslots(backend) <integer>
6600 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006601 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006602 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
6603
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006604 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
6605 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006606
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006607 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006608 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
6609 multiple backends (perhaps using acls to do name-based load balancing) and
6610 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
6611 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
6612 actually *down*, this acl is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006613 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006614
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006615 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
6616 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
6617 then this acl clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
6618 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08006619
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006620dst <ip_address>
6621 Applies to the local IPv4 address the client connected to. It can be used to
6622 switch to a different backend for some alternative addresses.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006623
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006624dst_conn <integer>
6625 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the same socket
6626 including the one being evaluated. It can be used to either return a sorry
6627 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
6628 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
6629 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
6630 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" criteria.
6631
6632dst_port <integer>
6633 Applies to the local port the client connected to. It can be used to switch
6634 to a different backend for some alternative ports.
6635
6636fe_conn <integer>
6637fe_conn(frontend) <integer>
6638 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
6639 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
6640 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
6641 frontend. It can be used to either return a sorry page before hard-blocking,
6642 or to use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is
6643 considered saturated. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn" and "fe_sess_rate"
6644 criteria.
6645
6646fe_id <integer>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006647 Applies to the frontend's id. Can be used in backends to check from which
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006648 frontend it was called.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02006649
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01006650fe_sess_rate <integer>
6651fe_sess_rate(frontend) <integer>
6652 Returns true when the session creation rate on the current or the named
6653 frontend matches the specified values or ranges, expressed in new sessions
6654 per second. This is used to limit the connection rate to acceptable ranges in
6655 order to prevent abuse of service at the earliest moment. This can be
6656 combined with layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for
6657 the rate to go down below the limit.
6658
6659 Example :
6660 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
6661 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
6662 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
6663 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
6664 frontend mail
6665 bind :25
6666 mode tcp
6667 maxconn 100
6668 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
6669 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
6670 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
6671 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006672
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006673nbsrv <integer>
6674nbsrv(backend) <integer>
6675 Returns true when the number of usable servers of either the current backend
6676 or the named backend matches the values or ranges specified. This is used to
6677 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
6678 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
6679 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01006680
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006681queue <integer>
Willy Tarreauf5a526f2010-09-01 08:06:18 +02006682queue(backend) <integer>
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006683 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
6684 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
6685 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
6686 one. This can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level,
6687 generally indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers.
6688 One possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones.
6689 See also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
6690
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006691sc1_bytes_in_rate
6692sc2_bytes_in_rate
6693 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
6694 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
6695 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
6696
6697sc1_bytes_out_rate
6698sc2_bytes_out_rate
6699 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
6700 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
6701 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
6702
6703sc1_conn_cnt
6704sc2_conn_cnt
6705 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
6706 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
6707
6708sc1_conn_cur
6709sc2_conn_cur
6710 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
6711 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
6712 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
6713
6714sc1_conn_rate
6715sc2_conn_rate
6716 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
6717 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
6718 See also src_conn_rate.
6719
6720sc1_get_gpc0
6721sc2_get_gpc0
6722 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
6723 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
6724
6725sc1_http_err_cnt
6726sc2_http_err_cnt
6727 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
6728 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
6729 See also src_http_err_cnt.
6730
6731sc1_http_err_rate
6732sc2_http_err_rate
6733 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
6734 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
6735 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
6736 src_http_err_rate.
6737
6738sc1_http_req_cnt
6739sc2_http_req_cnt
6740 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
6741 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
6742 src_http_req_cnt.
6743
6744sc1_http_req_rate
6745sc2_http_req_rate
6746 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
6747 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
6748 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
6749 src_http_req_rate.
6750
6751sc1_inc_gpc0
6752sc2_inc_gpc0
6753 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
6754 tracked counters, and returns its value. Before the first invocation, the
6755 stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
6756 return 1. The test can also be used alone and always returns true. This is
6757 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
6758 when a first ACL was verified :
6759
6760 acl abuse sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
6761 acl kill sc1_inc_gpc0
6762 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
6763
6764sc1_kbytes_in
6765sc2_kbytes_in
6766 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
6767 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
6768 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
6769 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
6770
6771sc1_kbytes_out
6772sc2_kbytes_out
6773 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
6774 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
6775 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
6776 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
6777
6778sc1_sess_cnt
6779sc2_sess_cnt
6780 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
6781 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
6782 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
6783 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
6784 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performend over the connection
6785 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
6786
6787sc1_sess_rate
6788sc2_sess_rate
6789 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
6790 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
6791 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
6792 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
6793 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
6794 performend over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
6795
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006796so_id <integer>
6797 Applies to the socket's id. Useful in frontends with many bind keywords.
6798
6799src <ip_address>
6800 Applies to the client's IPv4 address. It is usually used to limit access to
6801 certain resources such as statistics. Note that it is the TCP-level source
6802 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a proxy.
6803
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006804src_bytes_in_rate <integer>
6805src_bytes_in_rate(table) <integer>
6806 Returns the average bytes rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
6807 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
6808 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006809 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006810
6811src_bytes_out_rate <integer>
6812src_bytes_out_rate(table) <integer>
6813 Returns the average bytes rate to the connection's source IPv4 address in the
6814 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
6815 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006816 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006817
6818src_conn_cnt <integer>
6819src_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
6820 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
6821 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
6822 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006823 See also sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006824
6825src_conn_cur <integer>
6826src_conn_cur(table) <integer>
6827 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
6828 current connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table
6829 or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006830 returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006831
6832src_conn_rate <integer>
6833src_conn_rate(table) <integer>
6834 Returns the average connection rate from the connection's source IPv4 address
6835 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
6836 in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006837 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006838
6839src_get_gpc0 <integer>
6840src_get_gpc0(table) <integer>
6841 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
6842 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
6843 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006844 See also sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006845
6846src_http_err_cnt <integer>
6847src_http_err_cnt(table) <integer>
6848 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the current connection's
6849 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
6850 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006851 If the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006852
6853src_http_err_rate <integer>
6854src_http_err_rate(table) <integer>
6855 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the current connection's source
6856 IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
6857 table, measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table.
6858 This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006859 is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006860
6861src_http_req_cnt <integer>
6862src_http_req_cnt(table) <integer>
6863 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the current connection's
6864 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
6865 stick-table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006866 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006867
6868src_http_req_rate <integer>
6869src_http_req_rate(table) <integer>
6870 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the current connection's
6871 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
6872 stick-table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
6873 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006874 not found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006875
6876src_inc_gpc0 <integer>
6877src_inc_gpc0(table) <integer>
6878 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the connection's
6879 source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
6880 stick-table, and returns its value. If the address is not found, an entry is
6881 created and 1 is returned. The test can also be used alone and always returns
6882 true. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to
6883 mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
6884
6885 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
6886 acl kill src_inc_gpc0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006887 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006888
6889src_kbytes_in <integer>
6890src_kbytes_in(table) <integer>
6891 Returns the amount of data received from the connection's source IPv4 address
6892 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
6893 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
6894 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006895 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006896
6897src_kbytes_out <integer>
6898src_kbytes_out(table) <integer>
6899 Returns the amount of data sent to the connection's source IPv4 address in
6900 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
6901 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
6902 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006903 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02006904
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006905src_port <integer>
6906 Applies to the client's TCP source port. This has a very limited usage.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01006907
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006908src_sess_cnt <integer>
6909src_sess_cnt(table) <integer>
6910 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
6911 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
6912 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
6913 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006914 is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006915
6916src_sess_rate <integer>
6917src_sess_rate(table) <integer>
6918 Returns the average session rate from the connection's source IPv4 address in
6919 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
6920 amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A session is a
6921 connection that got past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006922 found, zero is returned. See also sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006923
6924src_updt_conn_cnt <integer>
6925src_updt_conn_cnt(table) <integer>
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02006926 Creates or updates the entry associated to the source IPv4 address in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006927 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table. This table
6928 must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise the match
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02006929 will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the expiration
6930 timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match can't return
6931 zero. This is used to reject service abusers based on their source address.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006932 Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-counters" instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02006933
6934 Example :
6935 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
6936 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
6937 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
6938 listen ssh
6939 bind :22
6940 mode tcp
6941 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006942 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +02006943 tcp-request content reject if { src_update_count gt 3 }
6944 server local 127.0.0.1:22
6945
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +02006946srv_is_up(<server>)
6947srv_is_up(<backend>/<server>)
6948 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
6949 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
6950 looked up in the current backend. The function takes no arguments since it
6951 is used as a boolean. It is mainly used to take action based on an external
6952 status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's availability).
6953 Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in using dummy servers
6954 as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from the CLI, so that
6955 rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
6956
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006957
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020069587.5.2. Matching contents at Layer 4 (also called Layer 6)
6959---------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006960
6961A second set of criteria depends on data found in buffers, but which can change
6962during analysis. This requires that some data has been buffered, for instance
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02006963through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request content"
6964keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006965
6966req_len <integer>
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02006967 Returns true when the length of the data in the request buffer matches the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02006968 specified range. It is important to understand that this test does not
6969 return false as long as the buffer is changing. This means that a check with
6970 equality to zero will almost always immediately match at the beginning of the
6971 session, while a test for more data will wait for that data to come in and
6972 return false only when haproxy is certain that no more data will come in.
6973 This test was designed to be used with TCP request content inspection.
6974
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02006975req_proto_http
6976 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
6977 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006978 is used so there should be no surprises. This test can be used for instance
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02006979 to direct HTTP traffic to a given port and HTTPS traffic to another one
6980 using TCP request content inspection rules.
6981
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02006982req_rdp_cookie <string>
6983req_rdp_cookie(name) <string>
6984 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol, and
6985 a cookie is present and equal to <string>. By default, any cookie name is
6986 checked, but a specific cookie name can be specified in parenthesis. The
6987 parser only checks for the first cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol
6988 specification. The cookie name is case insensitive. This ACL can be useful
6989 with the "MSTS" cookie, as it can contain the user name of the client
6990 connecting to the server if properly configured on the client. This can be
6991 used to restrict access to certain servers to certain users.
6992
6993req_rdp_cookie_cnt <integer>
6994req_rdp_cookie_cnt(name) <integer>
6995 Returns true when the data in the request buffer look like the RDP protocol
6996 and the number of RDP cookies matches the specified range (typically zero or
6997 one). Optionally a specific cookie name can be checked. This is a simple way
6998 of detecting the RDP protocol, as clients generally send the MSTS or MSTSHASH
6999 cookies.
7000
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007001req_ssl_ver <decimal>
7002 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like SSL, with a protocol
7003 version matching the specified range. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
7004 messages are supported. The test tries to be strict enough to avoid being
7005 easily fooled. In particular, it waits for as many bytes as announced in the
7006 message header if this header looks valid (bound to the buffer size). Note
7007 that TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. This test was designed to be used
7008 with TCP request content inspection.
7009
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +02007010wait_end
7011 Waits for the end of the analysis period to return true. This may be used in
7012 conjunction with content analysis to avoid returning a wrong verdict early.
7013 It may also be used to delay some actions, such as a delayed reject for some
7014 special addresses. Since it either stops the rules evaluation or immediately
7015 returns true, it is recommended to use this acl as the last one in a rule.
7016 Please note that the default ACL "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior
7017 declaration. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
7018 inspection.
7019
7020 Examples :
7021 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
7022 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
7023 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
7024
7025 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
7026 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
7027 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
7028 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
7029 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
7030 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
7031 tcp-request content reject
7032
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070347.5.3. Matching at Layer 7
7035--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007036
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007037A third set of criteria applies to information which can be found at the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007038application layer (layer 7). Those require that a full HTTP request has been
7039read, and are only evaluated then. They may require slightly more CPU resources
7040than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and response are indexed.
7041
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007042hdr <string>
7043hdr(header) <string>
7044 Note: all the "hdr*" matching criteria either apply to all headers, or to a
7045 particular header whose name is passed between parenthesis and without any
7046 space. The header name is not case-sensitive. The header matching complies
7047 with RFC2616, and treats as separate headers all values delimited by commas.
7048 Use the shdr() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7049
7050 The "hdr" criteria returns true if any of the headers matching the criteria
7051 match any of the strings. This can be used to check exact for values. For
7052 instance, checking that "connection: close" is set :
7053
7054 hdr(Connection) -i close
7055
7056hdr_beg <string>
7057hdr_beg(header) <string>
7058 Returns true when one of the headers begins with one of the strings. See
7059 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_beg() variant for
7060 response headers sent by the server.
7061
7062hdr_cnt <integer>
7063hdr_cnt(header) <integer>
7064 Returns true when the number of occurrence of the specified header matches
7065 the values or ranges specified. It is important to remember that one header
7066 line may count as several headers if it has several values. This is used to
7067 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
7068 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
7069 of certain headers. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use
7070 the shdr_cnt() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7071
7072hdr_dir <string>
7073hdr_dir(header) <string>
7074 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7075 isolated or delimited by slashes. This is used to perform filename or
7076 directory name matching, and may be used with Referer. See "hdr" for more
7077 information on header matching. Use the shdr_dir() variant for response
7078 headers sent by the server.
7079
7080hdr_dom <string>
7081hdr_dom(header) <string>
7082 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings either
7083 isolated or delimited by dots. This is used to perform domain name matching,
7084 and may be used with the Host header. See "hdr" for more information on
7085 header matching. Use the shdr_dom() variant for response headers sent by the
7086 server.
7087
7088hdr_end <string>
7089hdr_end(header) <string>
7090 Returns true when one of the headers ends with one of the strings. See "hdr"
7091 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_end() variant for
7092 response headers sent by the server.
7093
7094hdr_ip <ip_address>
7095hdr_ip(header) <ip_address>
7096 Returns true when one of the headers' values contains an IP address matching
7097 <ip_address>. This is mainly used with headers such as X-Forwarded-For or
7098 X-Client-IP. See "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the
7099 shdr_ip() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7100
7101hdr_reg <regex>
7102hdr_reg(header) <regex>
7103 Returns true when one of the headers matches of the regular expressions. It
7104 can be used at any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching
7105 is slower than other methods. See also other "hdr_" criteria, as well as
7106 "hdr" for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_reg() variant for
7107 response headers sent by the server.
7108
7109hdr_sub <string>
7110hdr_sub(header) <string>
7111 Returns true when one of the headers contains one of the strings. See "hdr"
7112 for more information on header matching. Use the shdr_sub() variant for
7113 response headers sent by the server.
7114
7115hdr_val <integer>
7116hdr_val(header) <integer>
7117 Returns true when one of the headers starts with a number which matches the
7118 values or ranges specified. This may be used to limit content-length to
7119 acceptable values for example. See "hdr" for more information on header
7120 matching. Use the shdr_val() variant for response headers sent by the server.
7121
7122http_auth(userlist)
7123http_auth_group(userlist) <group> [<group>]*
7124 Returns true when authentication data received from the client matches
7125 username & password stored on the userlist. It is also possible to
7126 use http_auth_group to check if the user is assigned to at least one
7127 of specified groups.
7128
7129 Currently only http basic auth is supported.
7130
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007131method <string>
7132 Applies to the method in the HTTP request, eg: "GET". Some predefined ACL
7133 already check for most common methods.
7134
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007135path <string>
7136 Returns true when the path part of the request, which starts at the first
7137 slash and ends before the question mark, equals one of the strings. It may be
7138 used to match known files, such as /favicon.ico.
7139
7140path_beg <string>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007141 Returns true when the path begins with one of the strings. This can be used
7142 to send certain directory names to alternative backends.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007143
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007144path_dir <string>
7145 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7146 slashes in the path. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7147 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7148 "url_dir" and "path_sub".
7149
7150path_dom <string>
7151 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7152 in the path. This may be used to perform domain name matching in proxy
7153 requests. See also "path_sub" and "url_dom".
7154
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007155path_end <string>
7156 Returns true when the path ends with one of the strings. This may be used to
7157 control file name extension.
7158
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007159path_reg <regex>
7160 Returns true when the path matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7161 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7162 than other methods. See also "url_reg" and all "path_" criteria.
7163
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007164path_sub <string>
7165 Returns true when the path contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7166 detect particular patterns in paths, such as "../" for example. See also
7167 "path_dir".
7168
7169req_ver <string>
7170 Applies to the version string in the HTTP request, eg: "1.0". Some predefined
7171 ACL already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
7172
7173status <integer>
7174 Applies to the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, eg: "302". It can be
7175 used to act on responses depending on status ranges, for instance, remove
7176 any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
7177
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007178url <string>
7179 Applies to the whole URL passed in the request. The only real use is to match
7180 "*", for which there already is a predefined ACL.
7181
7182url_beg <string>
7183 Returns true when the URL begins with one of the strings. This can be used to
7184 check whether a URL begins with a slash or with a protocol scheme.
7185
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007186url_dir <string>
7187 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with
7188 slashes in the URL. This is used to perform filename or directory name
7189 matching without the risk of wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also
7190 "path_dir" and "url_sub".
7191
7192url_dom <string>
7193 Returns true when one of the strings is found isolated or delimited with dots
7194 in the URL. This is used to perform domain name matching without the risk of
7195 wrong match due to colliding prefixes. See also "url_sub".
7196
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007197url_end <string>
7198 Returns true when the URL ends with one of the strings. It has very limited
7199 use. "path_end" should be used instead for filename matching.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007200
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007201url_ip <ip_address>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007202 Applies to the IP address specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request.
7203 It can be used to prevent access to certain resources such as local network.
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007204 It is useful with option "http_proxy".
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007205
7206url_port <integer>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007207 Applies to the port specified in the absolute URI in an HTTP request. It can
7208 be used to prevent access to certain resources. It is useful with option
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007209 "http_proxy". Note that if the port is not specified in the request, port 80
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007210 is assumed.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +01007211
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007212url_reg <regex>
7213 Returns true when the URL matches one of the regular expressions. It can be
7214 used any time, but it is important to remember that regex matching is slower
7215 than other methods. See also "path_reg" and all "url_" criteria.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007216
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007217url_sub <string>
7218 Returns true when the URL contains one of the strings. It can be used to
7219 detect particular patterns in query strings for example. See also "path_sub".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007220
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007221
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072227.6. Pre-defined ACLs
7223---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007224
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007225Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
7226every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007227order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007228
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007229ACL name Equivalent to Usage
7230---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007231FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +02007232HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007233HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
7234HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007235HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
7236HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
7237HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
7238HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
7239LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007240METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
7241METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
7242METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
7243METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
7244METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
7245METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +02007246RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007247REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007248TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007249WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
7250---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007251
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020072537.7. Using ACLs to form conditions
7254----------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007255
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007256Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
7257combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007258
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007259 - AND (implicit)
7260 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
7261 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007262
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007263A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007265 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007267Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
7268indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007270For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
7271"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
7272requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
7273is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007274
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007275 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7276 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
7277 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
7278 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007280To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
7281and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007282
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007283 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7284 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7285 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
7286 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007288 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
7289 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
7290 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
7291 use_backend www if host_www
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007292
Willy Tarreau95fa4692010-02-01 13:05:50 +01007293It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
7294expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
7295be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
7296the braces must be seen as independant words). Example :
7297
7298 The following rule :
7299
7300 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
7301 block if METH_POST missing_cl
7302
7303 Can also be written that way :
7304
7305 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
7306
7307It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
7308to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
7309simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
7310sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
7311good use is the following :
7312
7313 With named ACLs :
7314
7315 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7316 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7317 monitor fail if site_dead
7318
7319 With anonymous ACLs :
7320
7321 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
7322
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007323See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007324
Willy Tarreau5764b382007-11-30 17:46:49 +01007325
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010073267.8. Pattern extraction
7327-----------------------
7328
7329The stickiness features relies on pattern extraction in the request and
7330response. Sometimes the data needs to be converted first before being stored,
7331for instance converted from ASCII to IP or upper case to lower case.
7332
7333All these operations of data extraction and conversion are defined as
7334"pattern extraction rules". A pattern rule always has the same format. It
7335begins with a single pattern fetch word, potentially followed by a list of
7336arguments within parenthesis then an optional list of transformations. As
7337much as possible, the pattern fetch functions use the same name as their
7338equivalent used in ACLs.
7339
7340The list of currently supported pattern fetch functions is the following :
7341
7342 src This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session.
7343 It is of type IP and only works with such tables.
7344
7345 dst This is the destination IPv4 address of the session on the
7346 client side, which is the address the client connected to.
7347 It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
7348 typie IP and only works with such tables.
7349
7350 dst_port This is the destination TCP port of the session on the client
7351 side, which is the port the client connected to. This might be
7352 used when running in transparent mode or when assigning dynamic
7353 ports to some clients for a whole application session. It is of
7354 type integer and only works with such tables.
7355
Willy Tarreau4a568972010-05-12 08:08:50 +02007356 hdr(name) This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP
7357 request and converts it to an IP address. This IP address is
7358 then used to match the table. A typical use is with the
7359 x-forwarded-for header.
7360
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007361
7362The currently available list of transformations include :
7363
7364 lower Convert a string pattern to lower case. This can only be placed
7365 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7366 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7367
7368 upper Convert a string pattern to upper case. This can only be placed
7369 after a string pattern fetch function or after a conversion
7370 function returning a string type. The result is of type string.
7371
Willy Tarreaud31d6eb2010-01-26 18:01:41 +01007372 ipmask(mask) Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups
7373 and storage. This can be used to make all hosts within a
7374 certain mask to share the same table entries and as such use
7375 the same server. The mask can be passed in dotted form (eg:
7376 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
7377
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01007378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020073798. Logging
7380----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007381
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007382One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
7383provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
7384very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
7385provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
7386state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007387to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007388headers.
7389
7390In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
7391about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
7392send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
7393
7394 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
7395 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
7396 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
7397 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
7398 at the termination.
7399
7400The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
7401allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
7402as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
7403while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
7404real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
7405delay.
7406
7407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074088.1. Log levels
7409---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007410
7411TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with informations such as date, time,
7412source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
7413HTTP request, the HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, the conditions
7414in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values, to track a
7415particular user's problems for example. All messages are sent to up to two
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007416syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more info about log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007417facilities.
7418
7419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074208.2. Log formats
7421----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007422
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007423HAProxy supports 4 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007424and will be detailed in the next sections. A few of them may slightly vary with
7425the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain options. The supported
7426formats are the following ones :
7427
7428 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
7429 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
7430 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
7431 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
7432 extents.
7433
7434 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
7435 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
7436 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
7437 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
7438 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
7439
7440 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
7441 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
7442 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
7443 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
7444 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
7445
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007446 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
7447 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
7448 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
7449 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
7450
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007451Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
7452specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
7453field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
7454servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
7455always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
7456identifier.
7457
7458Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
7459 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
7460 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
7461 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
7462 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
7463
7464
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020074658.2.1. Default log format
7466-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007467
7468This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
7469as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
7470format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
7471
7472 Example :
7473 listen www
7474 mode http
7475 log global
7476 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7477
7478 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
7479 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
7480 (www/HTTP)
7481
7482 Field Format Extract from the example above
7483 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
7484 2 'Connect from' Connect from
7485 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
7486 4 'to' to
7487 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
7488 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
7489
7490Detailed fields description :
7491 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
7492 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7493 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
7494 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
7495 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7496 and processed the connection.
7497 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
7498
7499It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
7500will eventually disappear.
7501
7502
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020075038.2.2. TCP log format
7504---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007505
7506The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
7507is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
7508information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
7509counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
7510emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
7511environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
7512the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
7513sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007514specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
7515not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
7516fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
7517marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007518
7519 Example :
7520 frontend fnt
7521 mode tcp
7522 option tcplog
7523 log global
7524 default_backend bck
7525
7526 backend bck
7527 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7528
7529 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
7530 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
7531 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
7532
7533 Field Format Extract from the example above
7534 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
7535 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
7536 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
7537 4 frontend_name fnt
7538 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
7539 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
7540 7 bytes_read* 212
7541 8 termination_state --
7542 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
7543 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
7544
7545Detailed fields description :
7546 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
7547 connection to haproxy.
7548
7549 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7550
7551 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
7552 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
7553 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
7554 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
7555
7556 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7557 and processed the connection.
7558
7559 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
7560 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
7561 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
7562 applications.
7563
7564 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
7565 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
7566 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
7567 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
7568 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
7569
7570 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
7571 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
7572 See "Timers" below for more details.
7573
7574 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
7575 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
7576 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
7577 "Timers" below for more details.
7578
7579 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
7580 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
7581 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
7582 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
7583 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
7584 details.
7585
7586 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
7587 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
7588 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
7589 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
7590 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
7591
7592 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
7593 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
7594 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
7595 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
7596 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
7597 for more details.
7598
7599 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
7600 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
7601 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
7602 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
7603 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007604 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007605
7606 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
7607 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
7608 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
7609 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
7610 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
7611 caused by a denial of service attack.
7612
7613 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
7614 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
7615 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
7616 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
7617 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
7618 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
7619 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
7620 denial of service attack.
7621
7622 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
7623 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
7624 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
7625 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
7626 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
7627 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
7628 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
7629 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
7630 be processed than on other servers.
7631
7632 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
7633 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
7634 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
7635 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
7636 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
7637 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
7638 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
7639 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
7640 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
7641 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
7642 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
7643 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
7644 should not be attributed to the logged server.
7645
7646 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7647 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
7648 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
7649 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
7650 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
7651 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
7652 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
7653 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
7654
7655 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7656 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
7657 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
7658 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
7659 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
7660 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
7661 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
7662 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
7663 occurs.
7664
7665
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020076668.2.3. HTTP log format
7667----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007668
7669The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
7670is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
7671the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
7672are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
7673emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
7674generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
7675"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
7676which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007677frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
7678is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007679
7680Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
7681slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
7682with a star ('*') after the field name below.
7683
7684 Example :
7685 frontend http-in
7686 mode http
7687 option httplog
7688 log global
7689 default_backend bck
7690
7691 backend static
7692 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
7693
7694 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
7695 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
7696 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007697 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007698
7699 Field Format Extract from the example above
7700 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
7701 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
7702 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
7703 4 frontend_name http-in
7704 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
7705 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
7706 7 status_code 200
7707 8 bytes_read* 2750
7708 9 captured_request_cookie -
7709 10 captured_response_cookie -
7710 11 termination_state ----
7711 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
7712 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
7713 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
7714 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
7715 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007716
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007717
7718Detailed fields description :
7719 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
7720 connection to haproxy.
7721
7722 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
7723
7724 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
7725 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
7726 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
7727 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
7728 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
7729
7730 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
7731 and processed the connection.
7732
7733 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
7734 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
7735 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
7736
7737 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
7738 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
7739 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
7740 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
7741 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
7742 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
7743
7744 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
7745 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
7746 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
7747 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
7748 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
7749 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
7750
7751 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
7752 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
7753 See "Timers" below for more details.
7754
7755 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
7756 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
7757 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
7758 below for more details.
7759
7760 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
7761 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
7762 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
7763 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
7764 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
7765 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
7766 for more details.
7767
7768 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
7769 last close. It covers all possible processings. There is one exception, if
7770 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
7771 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
7772 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
7773 details.
7774
7775 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
7776 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
7777 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
7778
7779 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
7780 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
7781 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
7782 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
7783 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
7784 overflowing.
7785
7786 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
7787 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
7788 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
7789 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
7790 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
7791 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
7792 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
7793 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
7794
7795 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
7796 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
7797 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
7798 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
7799 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
7800 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
7801 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
7802 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
7803
7804 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
7805 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
7806 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
7807 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
7808 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
7809 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
7810 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
7811
7812 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
7813 the session was logged. It it useful to detect when some per-process system
7814 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
7815 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
7816 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007817 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007818 system.
7819
7820 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
7821 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
7822 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
7823 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
7824 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
7825 caused by a denial of service attack.
7826
7827 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
7828 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
7829 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
7830 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
7831 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
7832 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
7833 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
7834 denial of service attack.
7835
7836 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
7837 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
7838 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
7839 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
7840 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
7841 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
7842 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
7843 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
7844 processed than on other servers.
7845
7846 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
7847 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
7848 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
7849 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
7850 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
7851 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
7852 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
7853 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
7854 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
7855 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
7856 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
7857 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
7858 should not be attributed to the logged server.
7859
7860 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7861 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
7862 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
7863 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
7864 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
7865 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
7866 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
7867 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
7868
7869 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
7870 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
7871 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
7872 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
7873 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
7874 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
7875 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
7876 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
7877 occurs.
7878
7879 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
7880 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
7881 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
7882 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
7883 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
7884 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
7885 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
7886 cookies" below for more details.
7887
7888 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
7889 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
7890 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
7891 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
7892 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
7893 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
7894 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
7895 and cookies" below for more details.
7896
7897 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
7898 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
7899 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
7900 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
7901 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
7902 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
7903 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
7904 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
7905
7906
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079078.3. Advanced logging options
7908-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007909
7910Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
7911just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
7912options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
7913for more information about their usage.
7914
7915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079168.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
7917------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007918
7919It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
7920haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
7921commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
7922monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
7923ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
7924
7925 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
7926 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
7927 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
7928 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
7929
7930 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
7931 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
7932 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
7933 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipments
7934 such as other load-balancers.
7935
7936 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
7937 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
7938 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
7939
7940
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079418.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
7942----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007943
7944The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
7945what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
7946or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
7947"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
7948just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
7949log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
7950after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
7951is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
7952with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
7953with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
7954
7955
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079568.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
7957------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007958
7959Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
7960for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
7961"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
7962retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
7963raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
7964a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
7965file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
7966you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
7967"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
7968
7969
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079708.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
7971--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007972
7973Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
7974multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
7975them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
7976"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
7977logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
7978error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
7979and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
7980too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
7981useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
7982alternative.
7983
7984
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079858.4. Timing events
7986------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007987
7988Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
7989reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
7990the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
7991frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
7992mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
7993
7994 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
7995 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
7996 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
7997 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
7998 the client closes prematurely or times out.
7999
8000 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
8001 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
8002 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
8003 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
8004 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
8005
8006 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
8007 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
8008 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
8009 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
8010 connection never established.
8011
8012 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
8013 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
8014 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
8015 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
8016 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
8017 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
8018 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
8019 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
8020 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
8021 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
8022 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
8023
8024 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
8025 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
8026 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
8027 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
8028 transmission time, by substracting other timers when valid :
8029
8030 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
8031
8032 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
8033 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
8034 negative.
8035
8036These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
8037protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
8038that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008039due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008040close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
8041session has been aborted on timeout.
8042
8043Most common cases :
8044
8045 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8046 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
8047 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
8048 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
8049 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
8050 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
8051 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
8052 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
8053 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +02008054 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
8055 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
8056 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008057
8058 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
8059 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
8060 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
8061 of ms on remote networks.
8062
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008063 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
8064 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
8065 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008066
8067 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
8068 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
8069 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
8070 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
8071 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
8072 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
8073 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
8074 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
8075 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
8076 to the server until another one is released.
8077
8078Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
8079
8080 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
8081 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
8082 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
8083
8084 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
8085 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
8086 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
8087
8088 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
8089 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
8090 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
8091 flags.
8092
8093 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
8094 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
8095 Check the session termination flags, then check the
8096 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
8097 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
8098 the client connection was maintained open.
8099
8100 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
8101 a complete response in time, or it closed its connexion
8102 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
8103 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
8104
8105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020081068.5. Session state at disconnection
8107-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008108
8109TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
8110"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
81112-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
8112each of which has a special meaning :
8113
8114 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
8115 session to terminate :
8116
8117 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
8118
8119 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
8120 server explicitly refused it.
8121
8122 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
8123 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
8124 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
8125 error in server response which might have caused information leak
8126 (eg: cacheable cookie), or because the response was processed by
8127 the proxy (redirect, stats, etc...).
8128
8129 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
8130 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
8131 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
8132 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
8133 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
8134
8135 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
8136 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
8137 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
8138 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
8139 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
8140
8141 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
8142 send or receive data.
8143
8144 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
8145 send or receive data.
8146
8147 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
8148 with nothing left in the buffers.
8149
8150 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
8151
8152 R : th proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
8153 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
8154
8155 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
8156 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
8157 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
8158 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
8159 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
8160
8161 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
8162 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
8163
8164 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
8165 server (HTTP only).
8166
8167 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
8168
8169 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
8170 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
8171 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
8172
8173 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
8174 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
8175 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
8176
8177 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
8178
8179 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
8180 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
8181
8182 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
8183 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
8184 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
8185
8186 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
8187 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02008188 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
8189 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008190
8191 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
8192 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
8193 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
8194 another server.
8195
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008196 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008197 server.
8198
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008199 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
8200 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
8201 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
8202 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8203
8204 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
8205 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
8206 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
8207 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
8208
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008209 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8210
8211 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
8212 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
8213
8214 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
8215
8216 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
8217 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
8218 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
8219
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008220 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
8221 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
8222 happens everytime there is activity at a different date than the
8223 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
8224 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
8225
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008226 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
8227
8228 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
8229 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
8230
8231 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
8232
8233 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
8234
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008235The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
8236was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008237helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
8238starvation, attacks, etc...
8239
8240The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
8241alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
8242easier finding and understanding.
8243
8244 Flags Reason
8245
8246 -- Normal termination.
8247
8248 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
8249 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
8250 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
8251 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
8252
8253 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
8254 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
8255 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
8256 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
8257 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
8258 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008259
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008260 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8261 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
8262 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
8263
8264 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
8265 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
8266 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
8267
8268 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
8269 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
8270 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
8271 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
8272 the server takes too long to respond.
8273
8274 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
8275 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
8276 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
8277 long a time to respond.
8278
8279 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
8280 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
8281 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
8282 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
8283 and the client.
8284
8285 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
8286 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
8287 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
8288 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
8289 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
8290 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here.
8291
8292 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
8293 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008294 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
8295 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
8296 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
8297 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008299 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008300 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
8301 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
8302 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
8303 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
8304 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
8305
8306 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
8307 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
8308 503 or 504 here.
8309
8310 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
8311 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
8312 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
8313 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
8314 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
8315
8316 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
8317 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008318 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008319 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
8320 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
8321
8322 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
8323 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
8324 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
8325 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
8326 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
8327 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
8328 between haproxy and the server.
8329
8330 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
8331 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
8332 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
8333 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
8334 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
8335 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
8336 solution is to fix the application.
8337
8338 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
8339 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
8340 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
8341 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
8342 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
8343 external attacks.
8344
8345 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
8346 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
8347 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
8348 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
8349 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
8350
8351 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
8352 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
8353 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
8354 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
8355 containing unauthorized characters.
8356
8357 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
8358 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
8359 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
8360 returned an HTTP 403 error.
8361
8362 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
8363 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
8364 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
8365 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
8366
8367 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
8368 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
8369 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
8370 only be solved by proper system tuning.
8371
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02008372The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
8373persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
8374important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
8375re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
8376
8377 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
8378
8379 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8380 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
8381 set on a GET request.
8382
8383 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
8384 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
8385 a "server" entry is removed from the configuraton, since its cookie
8386 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
8387
8388 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
8389 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
8390 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
8391
8392 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
8393 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
8394 already got a cookie.
8395
8396 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8397 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
8398 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
8399 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
8400 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
8401
8402 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
8403 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8404 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8405
8406 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
8407 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
8408 new cookie was inserted in the response.
8409
8410 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
8411 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
8412
8413 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
8414 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
8415 then advertised in the response.
8416
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008417
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084188.6. Non-printable characters
8419-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008420
8421In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
8422consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
8423converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
8424prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
8425being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
8426escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
8427is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
8428'}' when logging headers.
8429
8430Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
8431issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
8432containing spaces is "User-Agent".
8433
8434Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
8435the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
8436performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
8437
8438
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084398.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
8440---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008441
8442Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
8443achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008444section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008445cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
8446the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
8447the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008448locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008449not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
8450user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
8451a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
8452wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
8453
8454 Examples :
8455 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
8456 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
8457
8458 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
8459 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
8460
8461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020084628.8. Capturing HTTP headers
8463---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008464
8465Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
8466proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
8467the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
8468server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
8469
8470Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
8471response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008472section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008473
8474It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008475time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
8476appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008477are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
8478and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
8479follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
8480request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
8481in the logs.
8482
8483 Example :
8484 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
8485 listen proxy-out
8486 mode http
8487 option httplog
8488 option logasap
8489 log global
8490 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
8491
8492 # log the name of the virtual server
8493 capture request header Host len 20
8494
8495 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
8496 capture request header Content-Length len 10
8497
8498 # log the beginning of the referrer
8499 capture request header Referer len 20
8500
8501 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
8502 capture response header Server len 20
8503
8504 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
8505 capture response header Content-Length len 10
8506
8507 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
8508 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
8509
8510 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
8511 capture response header Via len 20
8512
8513 # log the URL location during a redirection
8514 capture response header Location len 20
8515
8516 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
8517 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
8518 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8519 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
8520 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
8521
8522 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8523 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8524 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8525 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008526 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008527
8528 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
8529 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
8530 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
8531 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
8532 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008533 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008534
8535
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085368.9. Examples of logs
8537---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008538
8539These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
8540them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
8541reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
8542
8543 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
8544 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
8545 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
8546
8547 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
8548 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
8549
8550 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
8551 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
8552 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
8553
8554 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
8555 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
8556
8557 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
8558 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
8559 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8560
8561 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008562 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008563 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
8564 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
8565
8566 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
8567 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
8568 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
8569
8570 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
8571 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
8572 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensible information which
8573 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
8574 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
8575 to return the 502 and not the server.
8576
8577 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008578 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008579
8580 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
8581 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
8582 Nothing was sent to any server.
8583
8584 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
8585 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
8586
8587 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
8588 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
8589 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
8590 send a 408 return code to the client.
8591
8592 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
8593 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
8594
8595 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
8596 5 seconds ("c----").
8597
8598 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
8599 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008600 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008601
8602 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008603 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008604 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
8605 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
8606 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
8607 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
8608 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008609
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008610
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086119. Statistics and monitoring
8612----------------------------
8613
8614It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
8615mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
8616CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
8617Unix socket.
8618
8619
86209.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008621---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008622
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +01008623The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
8624page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
8625
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008626 0. pxname: proxy name
8627 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
8628 for server)
8629 2. qcur: current queued requests
8630 3. qmax: max queued requests
8631 4. scur: current sessions
8632 5. smax: max sessions
8633 6. slim: sessions limit
8634 7. stot: total sessions
8635 8. bin: bytes in
8636 9. bout: bytes out
8637 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008638 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008639 12. ereq: request errors
8640 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01008641 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008642 15. wretr: retries (warning)
8643 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +01008644 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008645 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
8646 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
8647 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
8648 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
8649 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
8650 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
8651 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
8652 25. qlimit: queue limit
8653 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
8654 27. iid: unique proxy id
8655 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
8656 29. throttle: warm up status
8657 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
8658 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008659 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +02008660 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
8661 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
8662 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02008663 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008664 UNK -> unknown
8665 INI -> initializing
8666 SOCKERR -> socket error
8667 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
8668 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
8669 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
8670 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
8671 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
8672 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
8673 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
8674 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
8675 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
8676 disable-on-404
8677 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
8678 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
8679 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +02008680 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
8681 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008682 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
8683 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
8684 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
8685 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
8686 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
8687 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008688 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
8689 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
8690 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
8691 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +01008692 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
8693 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008694
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008695
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020086969.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008697-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008698
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008699The following commands are supported on the UNIX stats socket ; all of them
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008700must be terminated by a line feed. The socket supports pipelining, so that it
8701is possible to chain multiple commands at once provided they are delimited by
8702a semi-colon or a line feed, although the former is more reliable as it has no
8703risk of being truncated over the network. The responses themselves will each be
8704followed by an empty line, so it will be easy for an external script to match a
8705given response with a given request. By default one command line is processed
8706then the connection closes, but there is an interactive allowing multiple lines
8707to be issued one at a time.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008708
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008709It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
8710on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
8711own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008712
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008713clear counters
8714 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
8715 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
8716 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
8717 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
8718 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
8719
8720clear counters all
8721 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
8722 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
8723 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
8724
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008725clear table <table> key <key>
8726 Remove entry <key> from the stick-table <table>. The key must be of the same
8727 type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4. This is typically used
8728 un unblock some users complaining they have been abusively denied access to a
8729 service, but this can also be used to clear some stickiness entries matching
8730 a server that is going to be replaced (see "show table" below for details).
8731 Note that sometimes, removal of a key will be refused because it is currently
8732 tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds later after the session ends is
8733 usuall enough.
8734
8735 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008736 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8737 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
8738 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
8739 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
8740 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
8741 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008742
8743 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8744
8745 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008746 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:1
8747 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
8748 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008749
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008750disable server <backend>/<server>
8751 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
8752 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
8753 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
8754 during the maintenance.
8755
8756 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
8757 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
8758
8759 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
8760 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
8761
8762 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
8763 level "admin".
8764
8765enable server <backend>/<server>
8766 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
8767 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
8768
8769 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
8770 their numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
8771
8772 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
8773 level "admin".
8774
8775get weight <backend>/<server>
8776 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
8777 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
8778 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
8779 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
8780 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
8781 dash ('#').
8782
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008783help
8784 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
8785 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +01008786
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008787prompt
8788 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
8789 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
8790 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
8791 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
8792 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
8793 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
8794 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
8795 command.
8796
8797quit
8798 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008799
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008800set timeout cli <delay>
8801 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
8802 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
8803 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
8804
8805set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
8806 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
8807 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
8808 configured weight. Relative weights are only permitted between 0 and 100%,
8809 and absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256. Servers which are part
8810 of a farm running a static load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations
8811 because the weight cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only
8812 accepted values are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take
8813 effect immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
8814 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to disable
8815 a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to enable it
8816 again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command is restricted
8817 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin". Both the
8818 backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by their
8819 numeric ID, prefixed with a dash ('#').
8820
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01008821show errors [<iid>]
8822 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
8823 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02008824 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
8825 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
8826 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01008827
8828 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
8829 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
8830 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
8831 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
8832 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
8833 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
8834 are reported too.
8835
8836 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
8837 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
8838 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
8839 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
8840 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
8841 code.
8842
8843 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
8844 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
8845 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
8846 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
8847 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
8848 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
8849 line.
8850
8851 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008852 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8853 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01008854 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
8855 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
8856
8857 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
8858 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
8859 00038 Location: blah\r\n
8860 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
8861 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
8862 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
8863 00204+ minal\r\n
8864 00211 \r\n
8865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008866 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +01008867 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
8868 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
8869 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
8870 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
8871 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
8872 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +01008873
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008874show info
8875 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
8876
8877show sess
8878 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02008879 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
8880 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
8881
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +01008882show sess <id>
8883 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
8884 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
8885 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
8886 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
8887 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
8888 freely evolve depending on demands.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008889
8890show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
8891 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
8892 possible to dump only selected items :
8893 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
8894 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
8895 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
8896 for example:
8897 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
8898 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
8899 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
8900
8901 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008902 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
8903 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008904 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
8905 Release_date: 2009/09/23
8906 Nbproc: 1
8907 Process_num: 1
8908 (...)
8909
8910 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
8911 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
8912 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
8913 (...)
8914 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
8915
8916 $
8917
8918 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
8919 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
8920 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
8921 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008922 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +02008923
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008924show table
8925 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
8926 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
8927 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
8928 entries currently in use.
8929
8930 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008931 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8932 >>> # table: front_pub, type: 0, size:204800, used:171454
8933 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: 0, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008934
8935show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ]
8936 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
8937 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
8938 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
8939 a filter in order to specify what entries to display. The filter then applies
8940 to the stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2). One stored data type
8941 has to be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table
8942 otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator>
8943 with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
8944 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
8945 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
8946 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
8947 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
8948 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
8949 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
8950
8951 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008952 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8953 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
8954 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
8955 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
8956 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
8957 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008958
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008959 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8960 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
8961 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
8962 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008963
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008964 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
8965 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
8966 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: 0, size:204800, used:2
8967 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
8968 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008969
8970 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
8971 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
8972 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
8973 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
8974 time goes, the average event rate drops.
8975
8976 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
8977 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
8978 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +02008979 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
8980 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +02008981 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
8982 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +02008983
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008984/*
8985 * Local variables:
8986 * fill-column: 79
8987 * End:
8988 */